Samsung Electronics Co 820SC PCS GSM/ EDGE Phone with Bluetooth User Manual 707SCII web

Samsung Electronics Co Ltd PCS GSM/ EDGE Phone with Bluetooth 707SCII web

Users Manual

Introduction
Thank you for purchasing the SoftBank 820SC.
٨Read this guide thoroughly before
using 820SC to ensure proper usage.
٨After reading this guide, keep it for
later reference.
٨Should you lose or damage this guide,
contact Customer Service ( P.25-25).
٨Accessible services may be limited by
contract conditions or service area.
820SC is compatible with both 3G and
GSM network technologies.
Note
Unauthorized copying of any part of this
guide is prohibited.
Contents are subject to change without
prior notice.
Not all functions and services described in
this user guide are available in Japan.
Steps have been taken to ensure the
accuracy of descriptions in this guide. If
you find inaccurate or missing
information, contact Customer Service
( P.25-25).
If there are any missing/misplaced pages
in this manual, SoftBank will replace it.
i
Accessories
Make sure the following accessories are included in the package with handset. These accessories are also sold
separately.
For details on accessories or optional items, contact Customer Service ( P.25-25).
*Utility Software updates/upgrades may become available via SoftBank Website (http://www.softbank.jp)
without prior notification. Please check for the newest versions of Utility Software and download as required.
Battery AC Charger
Utility
Software*
Stereo USB Cable
Earphone Conversion
Cable with Microphone
Tip
For more about accessories, contact SoftBank Customer Service ( P.25-25).
Battery and AC Charger are available for separate purchase.
ii
Contents
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .i
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ii
About This Guide. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii
Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .xiv
General Notes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .xxvi
SAR Certification Information. . . . . . . . . . . .xxxiii
FCC RF Exposure Information . . . . . . . . . . .xxxiv
European RF Exposure Information . . . . . . . xxxv
1 Getting Started
USIM Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
General Information & Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Inserting & Removing USIM Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
USIM PINs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
Handset Parts & Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
Handset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Display Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8
Sub Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
Battery & Charger. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-11
Before Using Battery or Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Inserting & Removing Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13
AC Charger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15
In-Car Charger (Optional) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16
Power On/Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17
Power On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-17
Power Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Time & Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18
Time & Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Time Zone Updating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19
Changing Home Time Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-20
820SC Menus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20
Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-20
Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-22
Switch Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-22
Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
Security Codes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
Phone Password. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-23
Center Access Code. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-23
Network Password. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-24
2 Basic Handset Operations
Initiating a Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Receiving a Call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-3
Reject Incoming Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
iii
Answer Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Activating & Canceling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Ringing Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Sound Language. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Checking Recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Engaged Call Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7
Earpiece Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Hold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Speaker Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Voice Recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Engaged Call Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Call Log Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
Viewing Call Log Records. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Calling from Call Log Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Deleting Call Log Records. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Call Log Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Call Manager . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11
Data Counter, Call Costs, & Call Times . . . . . . . . . 2-11
Edit Cost Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-12
Display Call Cost during a Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
International Roaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-13
Changing Network Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-13
Network Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
Calling from Outside Japan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Emergency Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16
3 Manner Profile
Minding Mobile Manners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
Manner Related Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-2
Manner Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Changing Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3
Offline Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
4 Entering Text
Text Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-2
Text Entry Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-2
Changing Text Entry Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-2
Key Assignments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3
Entering Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4
Hiragana/Kanji . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4
Katakana . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-6
Alphanumerics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7
Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8
Symbols, Pictograms & Emoticons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9
Line Breaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10
Quoting Saved Text. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-10
Hangul . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11
Editing Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11
Deleting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11
Copy/Cut, Paste & Undo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-12
iv
Jump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
Prediction (Japanese) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Learning (Japanese) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Font Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14
User Dictionary (Japanese). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-14
Saving to User Dictionary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
SMS Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-15
5 Phonebook
Saving to Phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2
Phonebook Entry Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Adding Entry Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4
Saving from Call Log Records. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Category Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-7
New Category (USIM Card) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Edit Category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Add Member . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Using Phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-9
Calling from Phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9
Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
Phonebook Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
Editing Phonebook Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Default Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Copy to USIM & Copy to Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
Deleting Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-15
My Phonebook Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-16
6 Video Call
Before Using Video Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Initiating a Video Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Receiving a Video Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Engaged Video Call Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Engaged Video Call Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5
Video Call Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Sending Your Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6
Selecting a Substitute Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6
Retry Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7
Voice Mute . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7
7 Mobile Camera
Before Using Mobile Camera. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Mobile Camera Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-2
Rotating Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-2
Using Display as Viewfinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3
Capturing a Still Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Camera Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-4
Capturing Still Images. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-5
v
Capturing Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-10
Video Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10
Recording Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11
Mobile Camera Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-13
Camera Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13
Video Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14
Viewing Images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-15
Viewing Still Images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
Viewing Videos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15
Editing Still Images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-15
Editing Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-17
Create Flash®. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-19
Attaching Images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-20
8 Display Settings
Standby Display Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2
Wallpaper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
Clock Display. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
Operator Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Menu Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5
Menu Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Popup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
List Font Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Zoom List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Backlight Brightness & Duration . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7
Adjusting Display Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7
Backlight Duration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7
Sub LCD Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8
Dialing Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8
Greeting Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9
Display Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10
9 Sound Settings
Changing Profile Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
10 Media Player
Before Using Media Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
Playing Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-3
Create Playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-5
Changing Music Player Settings . . . . . . . . . . . 10-6
Repeat Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6
Tone Volume. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Audio Skin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Visualization Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Playing Video. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Player Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-11
Repeat Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Tone Volume. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
vi
Resolution. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-12
11 Managing Files
(Data Fold-
er)
Data Folder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-2
Default Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-2
Saved Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-3
Opening Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-3
Using File Viewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-5
Viewing Graphics/Animation with the SVG-T/Flash®
Viewer
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-8
Sorting Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-9
Using Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-10
Using Image Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-10
Setting Sound File as Ringtone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11
Setting Video File as Ringtone. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-11
Setting Flash® file as Wallpaper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12
Saving a vFile. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-12
Data Folder Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-13
Managing Files/Folders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-14
Create Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14
Changing a File Name/Folder Name . . . . . . . . . . . 11-14
Moving a File/Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-15
Copying Files/Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11-16
Deleting a File/Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-17
Deleting a Content Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11-18
12 External Connections
External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
Bluetooth®. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-2
Before Using Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-2
Sending & Receiving Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-4
Connecting Handsfree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-9
Changing Bluetooth® Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-10
USB Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12-11
Connecting to a PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-12
Connecting to a Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12-12
13 Security
Change Phone Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2
PIN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-2
Changing PIN/PIN2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-2
PIN Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-3
Resetting PIN Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-3
USIM Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-4
Handset Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-5
Phone Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-5
Password Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-5
vii
Privacy Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
Activate Secret Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-6
Mobile Tracker. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-7
Rejecting Incoming Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-8
Reject Withheld . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-8
Reject Unavailable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Black List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-9
Restoring Defaults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13-10
Clear Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-10
Reset Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
Reset All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13-11
14 Tools
Alarms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-2
Wake-up Alarm/Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-2
Auto Power On. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-4
Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-5
Displaying Calendar. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-5
Saving New Entries to Calendar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-7
Viewing Saved Calendar Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-12
Editing Calendar Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-12
Deleting Calendar Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-13
Calendar Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-14
Voice Recorder. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-15
Voice Recorder Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-15
Recording Voice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-16
Playing Voice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-16
Changing Voice Recorder Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-17
World Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-18
Viewing World Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-18
Selecting Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-18
Using Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-19
Converting Currencies or Units . . . . . . . . . . 14-20
Converting Currencies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-20
Converting Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14-21
Stopwatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-22
Dictionary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-22
Interpreter (Japanese) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14-23
15 Advanced Functions
Calling Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-2
Auto Redial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-2
International Dial. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-2
Earphone call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-3
Handling Incoming Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15-5
Anykey Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-5
Acoustic Shock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-5
Active Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-6
Side Key Silence/Reject . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-6
viii
Side Key Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-6
Simple Search. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-7
Idle Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-7
Memory Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15-8
16 Optional Services
Optional Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-2
Call Forwarding. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-3
Activating Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-3
Cancel All. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-4
Check Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-4
Voice Mail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-5
Activating Voice Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-5
Canceling Voice Mail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6
Checking Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6
Listening to Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-6
Incoming Call Notification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-7
Call Waiting* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-8
Activating or Canceling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-8
Receiving a Second Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-8
Conference Call* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-9
New Call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-9
Engaged Conference Call Operations . . . . . . . . . . 16-10
Join . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-10
Call Barring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-11
Restrict Outgoing/Incoming Calls. . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-12
Cancel All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-12
Changing Network Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-13
Caller ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16-13
Show My Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-13
Adding 186 or 184. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16-14
17 Messaging
Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-2
Checking for New Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-2
Retrieving Complete Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-4
Using Received Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-5
Creating Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-6
Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-7
Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-8
Subject . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-10
Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-10
Sending a Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-11
Slide Show. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-12
Changing the Style of Message Field . . . . . . . . . . .17-12
Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-14
Attaching/Inserting Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-14
Attaching/Inserting a File from Data Folder, etc. into
Message Field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-15
ix
Creating & Inserting a File. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-18
Saving Created Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17-19
Save to Drafts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-19
Save as a Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17-20
18 Messaging Folders
Viewing Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-2
Message Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-2
Message Window Operations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-5
Replying to a Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-7
Forwarding a Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-8
Sending from Drafts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-8
Sending from Unsent Messages . . . . . . . . . . . .18-9
Deleting a Message. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-9
Deleting Specified Message(s). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-9
Designating & Deleting a Mailbox . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-10
Deleting All Messages from a Mailbox . . . . . . . . . 18-11
Linked Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-11
Saving to Phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-12
Saving as a Bookmark . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-12
Initiating a Call, Sending a Message, or Accessing the
Web
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-12
Using an Attachment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-13
Viewing an Attachment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-13
Saving Attachments to Data Folder. . . . . . . . . . . . .18-14
Managing Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-15
Create Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-15
Edit Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-15
Security ON/OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-15
Moving Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-16
Delete Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-16
From Message List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18-16
Saving to Phonebook. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-16
Sorting Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-17
Move to Phone/Move to USIM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-18
Saving an S! Mail Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-19
Message List Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18-20
19 Server Mail
Message List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-2
Acquire Mail List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19-2
Download . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19-2
Delete. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19-3
Remote Forward . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19-4
20 Other Message Settings
Customizing Handset Address. . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-2
x
S! Mail Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-2
Sending Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-2
Receiving Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-3
Message Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-4
Default Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-4
SMS Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-5
3D Pictogram Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-5
Reply with text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-6
21 Mobile Internet
Getting Started. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21-2
Getting Online . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21-3
Yahoo! Keitai Main Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-3
Enter URL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-3
Page Window Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21-4
Using Linked Info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21-6
22 Mobile Internet Files
Using Image Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-2
Saving Images to Data Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-2
Using Set As. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-3
Using Sound Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-4
Playing Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-4
Saving Sounds to Data Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-4
Using Video Files. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-6
Playing a Video . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-6
Saving Videos to Data Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-6
Streaming. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-7
Saving Pages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-8
Saving a Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-8
Opening a Saved Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-8
Changing a Title . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-8
Deleting a Saved Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-9
Saving Bookmarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-9
Saving as a Bookmark. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-9
Opening a Bookmark. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-10
Editing Bookmarks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-10
Deleting a Bookmark. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-11
History. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-11
Display Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22-12
Rendering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-12
Search Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-13
Copy Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-13
Reload . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-13
Page Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-14
Send URL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-14
Server Certificate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-14
Returning to Default Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-15
Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-15
Information Window Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22-15
xi
23 Other Web Settings
Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23-2
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23-2
Cookie Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-2
Turning Java Script On/Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-3
Text Size. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-3
Manufacture Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-3
Browser Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-3
Certificates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-4
Refresh Browser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23-4
Empty Cache/Empty Cookies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23-4
24 S! Appli
Getting Started. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-2
S! Appli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-2
Network S! Appli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-2
Downloading S! Appli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-2
Starting S! Appli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-3
Exit, Pause, & Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-3
Exiting or Pausing S! Appli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-3
Restarting a Paused S! Appli . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-4
Managing S! Appli. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-4
Details. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-4
Lock/Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-4
Delete. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-5
mPet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-5
Selecting Pet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-5
mPet Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-7
Other Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-9
Comic Surfing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-11
Browsing Electronic Comic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-11
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-12
S! Appli Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24-13
Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-13
Application Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-13
Vibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-14
S! Appli Sort . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-14
Reset S! Appli Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24-14
25 Appendix
Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-2
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-4
Software Update . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-10
Symbols & Pictograms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-12
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-12
Pictograms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-14
Memory List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25-15
xii
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-15
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-17
Warranty & After Sales Service. . . . . . . . . . .25-24
Customer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25-25
xiii
xii
About This Guide
In this guide, 820SC refers to SoftBank 820SC.
Instructions are described using mainly default
settings. When settings are changed, screen shots or
handset responses may differ from those depicted in
this guide.
Screen Shots and 820SC Illustrations
Screen shots appearing in this guide are for reference
only and may differ from actual Display images.
Product illustrations may vary from actual product
appearances.
Confirmations & Warning Messages
Messages not described in this guide may appear;
read all confirmations and warning messages
carefully.
Symbols
In this guide, symbols represent 820SC keys; see
"Handset Parts & Functions" ( P.1-6). Softkey and
Multi Selector operations are indicated as shown
below.
Operation options appear at the bottom of Display.
Press the corresponding Softkey to execute assigned
functions.
Softkey Operations
Softkeys
Save Select Play
Press c
to Select
Press o
to Play
Press w
to Save
xiii
Use Multi Selector to select menu items, move
cursor, and scroll, etc. In this guide, Multi Selector
operations are indicated as shown below.
Basic Multi Selector Operations
j : Press u or d
s : Press l or r
a : Press u, d, l, or r
Press
Assigned Function
Softkey
Multi Selector
Operations
u
lr
d
xiv
Highlighting
In this guide, "to highlight" means to move cursor to an item.
Menu Operations
Menu/Options operations are simplified with arrows.
Main Menu
Options
Highlight an item and press c (Select)
For details, see "820SC Menus" ( P.1-20).
APress and select Settings
Display settings Wallpaper
Press o (Options) to open Options
Highlight an item and press c (Select)
ASelect Options ψSend ψVia
bluetooth
xv
Safety Precautions
Read these safety precautions before
using handset.
Observe all precautions to avoid injury
to yourself and others, or damage to
property.
SoftBank is not liable for any damages
resulting from use of this product.
Before Using Handset
Symbols
Make sure you thoroughly understand these symbols
before reading on. Symbols and their meanings are
described below:
Great risk of death or serious injury from improper use
Risk of death or serious injury from improper use
Risk of injury or damage to property from improper use
Danger
Warning
Caution
Prohibited Actions
Compulsory Actions
Attention Required
xvi
Handset, Battery, & Charger
Use only specified battery and
Charger ( P.i).
Using non-specified equipment may cause
malfunctions, electric shock or fire due to battery
leakage, overheating, or bursting.
Do not short-circuit Charger Port.
Keep metal objects away from the Charger
Port. Keep handset away from jewelry. Battery may
leak, overheat, burst, or ignite causing injury. Use a
case to carry handset.
Battery
If battery fluid gets into your eyes,
do not rub them. Rinse with clean
water and consult a doctor
immediately.
Eyes may be severely damaged.
Prevent injury from battery
leakage, breakage, or fire. Do not:
Heat or dispose of battery in a fire.
Disassemble, modify, or break battery.
Damage or solder on to battery.
Use a damaged or deformed battery.
Use a non-specified charger.
Force battery into handset.
Charge or place battery near fire, heat sources or
expose it to extreme heat ( P.i).
Use battery for other equipments.
Danger
xvii
Handset, Battery, & Charger
Do not insert foreign objects into
handset.
Do not place metal or flammable objects in handset
or Charger. This may cause fire or electric shock.
Keep handset out of the reach of children.
Keep handset out of rain or
extreme humidity.
Fire or electric shock may occur.
Keep handset away from liquid-
filled containers.
Keep handset and Charger away from chemicals/
liquids. Fire or electric shock may result.
Avoid sources of fire.
To prevent fire or explosion, do not use
handset near gas or fine particles (Coal, dust, metal,
etc.).
Keep handset and Charger away
from microwave ovens.
Battery or handset may leak, burst, overheat, or
ignite.
Warning
xviii
Do not disassemble or modify
handset.
Do not open the housing of handset or Charger; it
may cause electric shock or injury. Contact the
SoftBank Customer Center, Customer Assistance
for repairs.
Do not modify handset or Charger. Fire or electric
shock may result.
If water or foreign matter gets
inside handset:
Discontinue handset use to prevent fire or electric
shock. Turn handset power off, remove battery,
unplug Charger and contact the SoftBank Customer
Center, Customer Assistance.
Do not subject handset to shocks.
Subjecting handset or Charger to shocks may
cause malfunction or injury. Should handset break,
remove battery and contact the SoftBank Customer
Center, Customer Assistance. Discontinue handset
use. Fire or electric shock may occur.
If an abnormality occurs:
Should there be any unusual sound, smoke,
or odor, discontinue handset use to avoid fire or
electric shock. Turn handset power off, remove
battery, unplug the Charger, and contact the
SoftBank Customer Center, Customer Assistance.
xix
Handset
Preventing accidents
For safety, never use handset while driving.
Pull over beforehand. Mobile phone use while
driving is prohibited by the revised Road Traffic
Law (Effective 1 November 2004).
Do not use headphones while driving or riding a
bicycle. Accidents may result.
Do not turn the volume up so high that ambient
sounds cannot be heard, especially when walking
in or around traffic to avoid accidents.
Do not swing handset by the strap.
Injury or breakage may result.
Turn handset power off before
boarding aircraft.
Using wireless devices aboard aircraft may cause
electronic malfunctions or endanger aircraft
operation.
Ringtone & Vibration Settings
Select settings carefully if you have a heart
condition or wear a pacemaker/defibrillator.
During thunderstorms, turn power
off; find cover.
There is a risk of a lightning strike or electric shock.
Do not use handset with wet hands.
Doing so may lead to electric shock or
damage to 820SC.
xx
Charger
Use only the specified voltage.
Non-specified voltages may cause fire or
electric shock.
AC Charger: AC 100V-240V Input
SoftBank is not liable for problems caused by
charging handset abroad.
In-Car Charger: DC 100V-240V Input
Do not use step up/down
transformers.
Use of the AC Charger with step up/down
transformers may cause fire, electric shock or
damage.
Do not use In-Car Charger inside
vehicles with a positive earth.
Fire may result. Use In-Car Charger only inside
vehicles with a negative earth.
Do not touch plug blades with wet
hands.
Electric shock may occur.
Do not use multiple cords in one
outlet.
Excess heat or fire may occurs.
Do not bend, twist, pull, or set
objects on the cord. Do not put
heavy objects on the cords or heat
or pull the cords.
Fire or electric shock may result.
Do not short-circuit Charger Port.
Keep the metal away from Port. Overheating,
fire, or electric shock may result.
xxi
Do not use AC/In-Car Charger if
the cord is damaged.
Fire or electric shock may be caused. Contact the
SoftBank Customer Assistance to replace the cord.
Be sure to secure In-Car Charger.
Avoid injury or accidents.
During thunderstorms:
Unplug the Charger to avoid damage, fire, or
electric shock.
Keep Charger out of the reach of
children.
Electric shock or injury may occur.
Battery
If battery does not charge properly,
stop charging.
Battery may overheat, burst or ignite.
If there is leakage or abnormal
odor, avoid fire sources.
It may catch fire or burst.
If there is abnormal odor, excessive
heat, discoloration, or distortion,
remove battery from handset.
It may leak, overheat, or explode.
xxii
Handset Use & Electronic Medical
Equipment
This section is based on "Guidelines on the Use of
Radio Communications Equipment such as Cellular
Telephones and Safeguards for Electronic Medical
Equipment" (Electromagnetic Compatibility
Conference, April 1997) and "Report of
Investigation of the Effects of Radio Waves on
Medical Equipment, etc." (Association of Radio
Industries and Businesses, March 2001).
People with implanted pacemakers/
defibrillators should keep handset
more than 22 cm away.
Implanted pacemakers/defibrillators may
malfunction due to radio waves.
Turn handset power off in crowded
places such as trains. People with
implanted pacemakers/
defibrillators may be near.
Implanted pacemakers/defibrillators may
malfunction due to radio waves.
Observe these rules inside medical
facilities:
Do not take handset into operating rooms or
Intensive or Coronary Care Units.
Keep handset off in hospitals.
Keep handset off in hospital lobbies. Electronic
equipment may be near.
Obey rules regarding mobile phone use in medical
facilities.
Consult the manufacturer of other
electronic medical equipment
about radio wave effects.
xxiii
Handset, Battery, & Charger
Handset Care
Place 820 SC on stable surfaces to avoid
malfunction or injury.
Keep 820 SC away from oily smoke or steam. Fire
or accidents may result.
Cold air from air conditioners may condense,
resulting in leakage, or burnout.
Keep 820 SC away from direct sunlight (Inside
vehicles, etc.) or heat sources. Distortion,
discoloration, or fire may occur. Battery shape may
be affected.
Keep 820 SC out of extremely cold places to avoid
malfunction or accidents.
Keep 820 SC away from fire sources to avoid
malfunction or accidents.
Usage Environment
Excessive dust may prevent heat release and cause
burnout or fire.
Avoid using 820SC on the beach. Sand may cause
malfunction or accidents.
Keep 820SC away from credit cards, phone cards,
etc. to avoid data loss.
Handset
Avoid leaving 820SC in extreme
heat (Inside vehicles, etc.).
Handset may heat up and lead to burns.
Volume settings
Keep handset volume moderate.
Excessive volume may cause damage to your
hearing.
Caution
xxiv
Headphones
Do not unplug by pulling the cord; may
damage the cord.
Keep the plug clean to avoid noise or malfunction.
Inside vehicles:
Handset use may cause other electronic
equipment to malfunction.
Should skin irritation occur,
discontinue handset use and
consult a doctor.
Skin irritation, rashes, or itchiness may result
depending on your physical condition.
Charger
Charger & In-Car Charger
Grasp the plug (not the cord) to disconnect
Charger. Otherwise, fire or electric shock
may result.
Keep the cord away from heaters. Exposed wire
may cause fire or electric shock.
Parts Materials &
Finishing
Housing (Display side) Mg
Housing (Speaker part, Battery Cover
side) PC
Housing (Sub Display side) PCGF30%
Housing (Keys side) PCGF20%
Keypad Mixture material
Charger & External Device Port
Cover
Mixture material/
UV coating
Battery Cover PC
Side keys Mixture material/
UV coating
Rotate Camera PC/UV coating
Camera Ornament PC/UV coating
Hinge Cap Zinc Alloy/
Nickel coating
Strap Eyelet ZnABS resin
Strap Eyelet Cap ABS resin
Urethane coating
Parts Materials &
Finishing
xxv
Stop use if the plug is hot or improperly
connected. Fire or electric shock may
result.
Keep In-Car Charger socket clean. If might
overheat and cause injury.
Use only the specified fuse
A 1A fuse is specified for In-Car Charger. An
improper fuse may cause damage or fire.
Always charge 820SC in a well-
ventilated area.
Avoid covering/wrapping Charger; may cause
damage or fire.
Do not use In-Car Charger when
engine is off.
Start engine before use; may weaken car battery.
Disconnect AC/In-Car Charger
during long periods of disuse.
Be sure to unplug AC/In-Car Charger after use.
xxvi
Handset Maintenance
When cleaning, disconnect AC/In-Car
Charger to prevent shock or injury.
Installing In-Car Charger
Properly position the cable for safe driving to
avoid injury or accidents.
Battery
Keep battery out of the reach of
children.
They may sustain injuries. And when using, do not
let them remove battery from handset.
Do not leave battery in direct
sunlight or inside vehicles.
Overheating or fire may occur and performance may
be reduced.
Do not expose battery to liquids.
Performance may deteriorate.
If battery fluid makes contact with
skin or clothes:
Rinse with clean water immediately.
Do not dispose of exhausted
batteries with ordinary refuse.
Tape over battery terminals before disposal, or bring
them to a SoftBank shop. Follow local regulations
regarding battery disposal.
Do not throw or abuse battery.
Battery may overheat, burst, or ignite.
xxvii
Charge battery within a range of
5°C - 40°C.
Battery may leak/overheat and performance may
deteriorate.
If a child is using handset, explain
all these instructions and supervise
handset’s usage.
If there is any abnormal odor or
excessive heat, stop using battery
and call the SoftBank Customer Center,
Customer Assistance.
Do not leave battery uncharged.
Charge at least once every six
months.
xxviii
General Notes
General Use
• SoftBank is not liable for any damages
resulting from accidental loss/alteration of
any data on handset. Please keep separate
records of Phonebook entries, etc.
• Handset transmissions may be disrupted
inside buildings, tunnels, or underground,
or when moving into/out of such places.
• Use handset without disturbing others.
• Handsets are radios as stipulated by the
Radio Law. Under the Radio Law,
handsets must be submitted for inspection
upon request.
• Handset use near landlines, TVs or radios
may cause interference.
Beware of eavesdropping.
Because this service is completely digital,
the possibility of signal interception is
greatly reduced. However, some
transmissions may be overheard.
Eavesdropping
Deliberate/accidental interception of
communications constitutes
eavesdropping.
Inside Vehicles
• Never use handset while driving.
• Do not park illegally to use handset.
• Handset use may affect a vehicle's
electronic equipment.
Aboard Aircraft
Never use handset aboard aircraft (Keep the power
off).
xxix
Handset use may impair aircraft operation.
Function Usage Limits
• These functions are disabled after handset
upgrade/replacement or service
cancellation:
Camera; Media Player; S! Applications.
• After a period of disuse, these functions
may be unusable; establish a Network
connection to restore usability.
Handset Care
• If handset is left with no battery or an
exhausted one, data may be altered/lost.
SoftBank is not liable for any resulting
damages.
• Use handset between 5qC - 40qC.
• Avoid extreme temperatures/direct
sunlight.
xxx
• Exposing the lens to direct sunlight may
damage the color filter and affect image
color.
• Do not drop or subject handset to shocks.
• Clean handset with a dry, soft cloth. Using
alcohol, thinner, etc. may damage it.
• Do not expose handset to rain, snow, or
high humidity.
• Never disassemble or modify handset.
• Avoid scratching Display.
• When closing handset, keep straps, etc.
outside to avoid damaging Display.
• When using headphones, moderate the
volume to avoid sound bleed.
• Handset is not water-proof. Avoid
exposure to liquids and high humidity.
Keep handset away from precipitation.
Cold air from air conditioning, etc. may
condense causing corrosion.
Avoid placing handset in damp places
(Restrooms, bath/shower rooms, etc.).
On the beach, keep handset away from
water and direct sunlight.
Perspiration may get inside handset
causing malfunction.
• Heavy objects or excessive pressure
should be avoided. This may cause
malfunction or injury.
Do not sit down with handset in a back
pocket.
Do not place heavy objects on handset in
a bag.
• Insert only specified devices into
Headphone Port. Malfunction or damage
may result.
• Always turn power off before removing
battery. If battery is removed while saving
data or sending mail, data may be lost,
changed or destroyed.
xxxi
Copyrights
Copyright laws protect sounds, images, computer
programs, databases, other materials for copyright
holders. Duplicated material is limited to private use
only.
Use of materials beyond this limit or without
permission of copyright holders may constitute
copyright infringement, and be subject to criminal
punishment. Comply with copyright laws when using
images captured with handset camera.
The software contained in 820SC is copyrighted
material; copyright, moral right, and other related
rights are protected by copyright laws. Do not copy,
modify, alter, disassemble, decompile, or reverse-
engineer the software, and do not separate it from
hardware in whole or part.
Trademarks
Licensed by QUALCOMM
Incorporated under one or more of the
following United States Patents and/or
their counterparts in other nations:
4,901,307 5,490,165 5,056,109
5,504,773 5,101,501 5,506,865
5,109,390 5,511,073 5,228,054
5,535,239 5,267,261 5,544,196
5,267,262 5,568,483 5,337,338
5,600,754 5,414,796 5,657,420
5,416,797 5,659,569 5,710,784
5,778,338
Video Call, 3D Pictgram, S! Appli, S!
Mail and Mail Art are trademarks or
registered trademarks of SOFTBANK
MOBILE Corp.
xxxii
• "ComicSurfing®" is a trademark or
registered trademark of CELSYS, Inc.
"SOFTBANK," SOFTBANK's
equivalent in Japanese, and the
SOFTBANK logo are trademarks or
registered trademarks of SOFTBANK
CORP. in Japan and in other countries.
Yahoo! and the "Yahoo!" or "Y!" logos
are trademarks or registered trademarks
of Yahoo! Inc.
This product contains ACCESS Co.,
Ltd.’s NetFront Internet browser
software. NetFront is a trademark or
registered trademark of ACCESS Co.,
Ltd. in Japan and in other
countries.
Part of the software in this product
incorporates a module developed by
the Independent JPEG Group.
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED
UNDER THE MPEG-4 VISUAL
PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR
THE PERSONAL AND NON-
COMMERCIAL USE OF A
CONSUMER FOR (i) ENCODING
VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH
THE MPEG-4 VISUAL STANDARD
("MPEG-4 VIDEO") AND/OR (ii)
DECODING MPEG-4 VIDEO THAT
WAS ENCODED BY A CONSUMER
ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND
NONCOMMERCIAL ACTIVITY
AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A
VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED BY
MPEG LA TO PROVIDE MPEG-4
xxxiii
VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS GRANTED
OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY
OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION INCLUDING THAT
RELATING TO PROMOTIONAL,
INTERNAL AND COMMERCIAL
USES AND LICENSING MAY BE
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, LLC.
SEE HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM.
Contains Macromedia® Flash® Flash
LiteTM technology by Adobe Systems
Incorporated.
• Copyright© 1995-2005 Adobe Systems
Incorporated. All rights reserved.
Macromedia, Flash, Macromedia
Flash, and Macromedia Flash Lite are
trademarks or registered trademarks of
Adobe Systems Incorporated in the
United States and other countries.
• JBlendTM is incorporated in this
product. JBlendTM is a JavaTM execution
environment developed by Aplix
Corporation for implementing
advanced performance and fast
operation on small-memory systems.
Powered by JBlendTM
Technology.
JBlend and JBlend logos are
registered trademarks of Aplix
Corporation in Japan and other
countries.
Powered by JBlendTM,©1997-2006
Aplix Corporation.
All rights reserved.
xxxiv
JBlend and all JBlend-based
trademarks and logos are trademarks or
registered trademarks of Aplix
Corporation in Japan and other
countries.
• Chaku-Uta® and Chaku-Uta Full® are
registered trade marks of Sony Music
Entertainment Corp.
Java and all Java-based
trademarks and logos are
trademarks or registered
trademarks of Sun Microsystems, Inc.
in the United States and other
countries.
Bluetooth is a trademark of
the
Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
The Bluetooth word mark and logos are
owned by the Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and
any use of such marks by Samsung
Electronics is under license. Other
trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
xxxv
Bluetooth
®
In the frequency band of the Bluetooth®
functions of 820SC, Industrial, scientific
or medical equipments such as
microwave ovens or in-house radio
stations such as the ones used in
production lines or by amateur radio
stations (Referred to as "other radio
stations" hereafter) are used. In order to
prevent radio interference with other
radio equipments, follow the points
listed below in using handset.
1.Before using Bluetooth® functions,
confirm there are no "other radio
stations" operating near you.
2.In case there is a radio interference
with "other radio stations," move to
some other place or stop the
Bluetooth® functions (Stop emitting
the radio waves) immediately.
3.If you have any questions or problems
with Bluetooth® emissions, contact
SoftBank as listed below:
Contact: SoftBank Customer Center
From a SoftBank handset, dial 157 (toll free) for
General Information. See "Customer Service"
( P.25-25) for landline numbers by service area.
820SC transmits on the 2.4 GHz band, employing
frequency-hopping spread spectrum (FHSS)
modulation, with resistance to radio frequency
interference between 1.5 - 5 meters, depending on
usage environment.
xxxvii
Health and Safety Information
Exposure to Radio Frequency (RF)
Signals
Certification Information (SAR)
Your wireless phone is a radio transmitter and
receiver. It is designed and manufactured not to
exceed the exposure limits for radio frequency (RF)
energy set by the Federal Communications
Commission (FCC) of the U.S. government. These
FCC exposure limits are derived from the
recommendations of two expert organizations, the
National Counsel on Radiation Protection and
Measurement (NCRP) and the Institute of Electrical
and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). In both cases, the
recommendations were developed by scientific and
engineering experts drawn from industry,
government, and academia after extensive reviews of
the scientific literature related to the biological
effects of RF energy.The exposure limit set by the
FCC for wireless mobile phones employs a unit of
measurement known as the Specific Absorption Rate
(SAR). The SAR is a measure of the rate of
absorption of RF energy by the human body
expressed in units of watts per kilogram (W/kg). The
FCC requires wireless phones to comply with a
safety limit of 1.6 watts per kilogram (1.6 W/kg).
The FCC exposure limit incorporates a substantial
margin of safety to give additional protection to the
public and to account for any variations in
measurements.SAR tests are conducted using
standard operating positions accepted by the FCC
with the phone transmitting at its highest certified
power level in all tested frequency bands. Although
the SAR is determined at the highest certified power
xxxviii
level, the actual SAR level of the phone while
operating can be well below the maximum value.
This is because the phone is designed to operate at
multiple power levels so as to use only the power
required to reach the network. In general, the closer
you are to a wireless base station antenna, the lower
the power output.Before a new model phone is
available for sale to the public, it must be tested and
certified to the FCC that it does not exceed the
exposure limit established by the FCC. Tests for each
model phone are performed in positions and
locations (e.g. at the ear and worn on the body) as
required by the FCC.
The highest SAR values for this model phone as
reported to the FCC are GSM1900 Mode(Part 24)
Head: 0.077 W/Kg, Body-worn: 0.171 W/Kg. For
body worn operation, this model phone has been tested
and meets the FCC RF exposure guidelines whenused
with a Samsung accessory designated for this product
or when used with an accessory that contains no metal
add that positions the handset a minimum of 1.5 cm
from the body. Non-compliance with the above
restrictions may result in violation of FCC RF exposure
guidelines. SAR information on this and other model
phones can be viewed on-line at www.fcc.gov/oet/
fccid. This site uses the phone FCC ID number,
A3L820SC. Sometimes it may be necessary to
remove the battery pack to find the number. Once
you have the FCC ID number for a particular phone,
follow the instructions on the website and it should
provide values for typical or maximum SAR for a
particular phone. Additional product specific SAR
information can also be obtained at www.fcc.gov/
cgb/sar.
Consumer Information on Wireless
Phones
The U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA) has
published a series of Questions and Answers for
consumers relating to radio frequency (RF) exposure
xxxix
from wireless phones. The FDA publication includes
the following information:
What kinds of phones are the subject of this
update?
The term wireless phone refers here to hand-held
wireless phones with built-in antennas, often called
°×cell,°± °×mobile,°± or °×PCS°± phones. These
types of wireless phones can expose the user to
measurable radio frequency energy (RF) because of
the short distance between the phone and the user's
head. These RF exposures are limited by Federal
Communications Commission safety guidelines that
were developed with the advice of FDA and other
federal health and safety agencies. When the phone is
located at greater distances from the user, the
exposure to RF is drastically lower because a
person's RF exposure decreases rapidly with
increasing distance from the source. The so-called
°×cordless phones,°± which have a base unit
connected to the telephone wiring in a house,
typically operate at far lower power levels, and thus
produce RF exposures well within the FCC's
compliance limits.
Do wireless phones pose a health hazard?
The available scientific evidence does not show that
any health problems are associated with using
wireless phones. There is no proof, however, that
wireless phones are absolutely safe. Wireless phones
emit low levels of radio frequency energy (RF) in the
microwave range while being used. They also emit
very low levels of RF when in the stand-by mode.
Whereas high levels of RF can produce health effects
(by heating tissue), exposure to low level RF that
does not produce heating effects causes no known
adverse health effects. Many studies of low level RF
exposures have not found any biological effects.
Some studies have suggested that some biological
effects may occur, but such findings have not been
xl
confirmed by additional research. In some cases,
other researchers have had difficulty in reproducing
those studies, or in determining the reasons for
inconsistent results.
What is FDA's role concerning the safety of
wireless phones?
Under the law, FDA does not review the safety of
radiation-emitting consumer products such as
wireless phones before they can be sold, as it does
with new drugs or medical devices. However, the
agency has authority to take action if wireless phones
are shown to emit radio frequency energy (RF) at a
level that is hazardous to the user. In such a case,
FDA could require the manufacturers of wireless
phones to notify users of the health hazard and to
repair, replace or recall the phones so that the hazard
no longer exists.Although the existing scientific data
do not justify FDA regulatory actions, FDA has
urged the wireless phone industry to take a number
of steps, including the following:.
Support needed research into possible biological
effects of RF of the type emitted by wireless
phones;.
Design wireless phones in a way that minimizes
any RF exposure to the user that is not necessary
for device function; and.
Cooperate in providing users of wireless phones
with the best possible information on possible
effects of wireless phone use on human health.
FDA belongs to an interagency working group of the
federal agencies that have responsibility for different
aspects of RF safety to ensure coordinated efforts at
the federal level. The following agencies belong to
this working group:.
National Institute for Occupational Safety and
Health.
Environmental Protection Agency.
Federal Communications Commission.
Occupational Safety and Health Administration.
xli
National Telecommunications and Information
Administration
The National Institutes of Health participates in some
interagency working group activities, as well.
FDA shares regulatory responsibilities for wireless
phones with the Federal Communications
Commission (FCC). All phones that are sold in the
United States must comply with FCC safety
guidelines that limit RF exposure. FCC relies on
FDA and other health agencies for safety questions
about wireless phones.
FCC also regulates the base stations that the wireless
phone networks rely upon. While these base stations
operate at higher power than do the wireless phones
themselves, the RF exposures that people get from
these base stations are typically thousands of times
lower than those they can get from wireless phones.
Base stations are thus not the primary subject of the
safety questions discussed in this document.
What are the results of the research done
already?
The research done thus far has produced conflicting
results, and many studies have suffered from flaws in
their research methods. Animal experiments
investigating the effects of radio frequency energy
(RF) exposures characteristic of wireless phones
have yielded conflicting results that often cannot be
repeated in other laboratories. A few animal studies,
however, have suggested that low levels of RF could
accelerate the development of cancer in laboratory
animals. However, many of the studies that showed
increased tumor development used animals that had
been genetically engineered or treated with cancer-
causing chemicals so as to be pre-disposed to
develop cancer in absence of RF exposure. Other
studies exposed the animals to RF for up to 22 hours
per day. These conditions are not similar to the
conditions under which people use wireless phones,
xlii
so we don't know with certainty what the results of
such studies mean for human health.
Three large epidemiology studies have been
published since December 2000. Between them, the
studies investigated any possible association between
the use of wireless phones and primary brain cancer,
glioma, meningioma, or acoustic neuroma, tumors of
the brain or salivary gland, leukemia, or other
cancers. None of the studies demonstrated the
existence of any harmful health effects from wireless
phones RF exposures. However, none of the studies
can answer questions about long-term exposures,
since the average period of phone use in these studies
was around three years.
What research is needed to decide whether
RF exposure from wireless phones poses a
health risk?
A combination of laboratory studies and
epidemiological studies of people actually using
wireless phones would provide some of the data that
are needed. Lifetime animal exposure studies could
be completed in a few years. However, very large
numbers of animals would be needed to provide
reliable proof of a cancer promoting effect if one
exists. Epidemiological studies can provide data that
is directly applicable to human populations, but ten
or more years' follow-up may be needed to provide
answers about some health effects, such as cancer.
This is because the interval between the time of
exposure to a cancer-causing agent and the time
tumors develop - if they do - may be many, many
years. The interpretation of epidemiological studies
is hampered by difficulties in measuring actual RF
exposure during day-to-day use of wireless phones.
Many factors affect this measurement, such as the
angle at which the phone is held, or which model of
phone is used.
xliii
What is FDA doing to find out more about
the possible health effects of wireless phone
RF?
FDA is working with the U.S. National Toxicology
Program and with groups of investigators around the
world to ensure that high priority animal studies are
conducted to address important questions about the
effects of exposure to radio frequency energy
(RF).FDA has been a leading participant in the
World Health Organization international
Electromagnetic Fields (EMF) Project since its
inception in 1996. An influential result of this work
has been the development of a detailed agenda of
research needs that has driven the establishment of
new research programs around the world. The
Project has also helped develop a series of public
information documents on EMF issues.
FDA and Cellular Telecommunications & Internet
Association (CTIA) have a formal Cooperative
Research and Development Agreement (CRADA) to
do research on wireless phone safety. FDA provides
the scientific oversight, obtaining input from experts
in government, industry, and academic organizations.
CTIA-funded research is conducted through
contracts to independent investigators. The initial
research will include both laboratory studies and
studies of wireless phone users. The CRADA will
also include a broad assessment of additional
research needs in the context of the latest research
developments around the world.
What steps can I take to reduce my
exposure to radio frequency energy from
my wireless phone?
If there is a risk from these products - and at this
point we do not know that there is - it is probably
very small. But if you are concerned about avoiding
even potential risks, you can take a few simple steps
to minimize your exposure to radio frequency energy
(RF). Since time is a key factor in how much
xliv
exposure a person receives, reducing the amount of
time spent using a wireless phone will reduce RF
exposure.
If you must conduct extended conversations by
wireless phone every day, you could place more
distance between your body and the source of the
RF, since the exposure level drops off dramatically
with distance. For example, you could use a
headset and carry the wireless phone away from
your body or use a wireless phone connected to a
remote antenna.
Again, the scientific data do not demonstrate that
wireless phones are harmful. But if you are
concerned about the RF exposure from these
products, you can use measures like those described
above to reduce your RF exposure from wireless
phone use.
What about children using wireless phones?
The scientific evidence does not show a danger to
users of wireless phones, including children and
teenagers. If you want to take steps to lower exposure
to radio frequency energy (RF), the measures
described above would apply to children and
teenagers using wireless phones. Reducing the time
of wireless phone use and increasing the distance
between the user and the RF source will reduce RF
exposure.
Some groups sponsored by other national
governments have advised that children be
discouraged from using wireless phones at all. For
example, the government in the United Kingdom
distributed leaflets containing such a
recommendation in December 2000. They noted that
no evidence exists that using a wireless phone causes
brain tumors or other ill effects. Their
recommendation to limit wireless phone use by
children was strictly precautionary; it was not based
on scientific evidence that any health hazard exists.
xlv
Do hands-free kits for wireless phones
reduce risks from exposure to RF
emissions?
Since there are no known risks from exposure to RF
emissions from wireless phones, there is no reason to
believe that hands-free kits reduce risks. Hands-free
kits can be used with wireless phones for
convenience and comfort. These systems reduce the
absorption of RF energy in the head because the
phone, which is the source of the RF emissions, will
not be placed against the head. On the other hand, if
the phone is mounted against the waist or other part
of the body during use, then that part of the body will
absorb more RF energy. Wireless phones marketed in
the U.S. are required to meet safety requirements
regardless of whether they are used against the head
or against the body. Either configuration should
result in compliance with the safety limit.
Do wireless phone accessories that claim to
shield the head from RF radiation work?
Since there are no known risks from exposure to RF
emissions from wireless phones, there is no reason to
believe that accessories that claim to shield the head
from those emissions reduce risks. Some products
that claim to shield the user from RF absorption use
special phone cases, while others involve nothing
more than a metallic accessory attached to the phone.
Studies have shown that these products generally do
not work as advertised. Unlike “hand-free” kits,
these so-called “shields” may interfere with proper
operation of the phone. The phone may be forced to
boost its power to compensate, leading to an increase
in RF absorption. In February 2002, the Federal trade
Commission (FTC) charged two companies that sold
devices that claimed to protect wireless phone users
from radiation with making false and unsubstantiated
claims. According to FTC, these defendants lacked a
reasonable basis to substantiate their claim.
xlvi
What about wireless phone interference
with medical equipment?
Radio frequency energy (RF) from wireless phones
can interact with some electronic devices. For this
reason, FDA helped develop a detailed test method to
measure electromagnetic interference (EMI) of
implanted cardiac pacemakers and defibrillators
from wireless telephones. This test method is now
part of a standard sponsored by the Association for
the Advancement of Medical instrumentation
(AAMI). The final draft, a joint effort by FDA,
medical device manufacturers, and many other
groups, was completed in late 2000. This standard
will allow manufacturers to ensure that cardiac
pacemakers and defibrillators are safe from wireless
phone EMI. FDA has tested wireless phones and
helped develop a voluntary standard sponsored by
the Institute of Electrical and Electronic Engineers
(IEEE). This standard specifies test methods and
performance requirements for hearing aids and
wireless phones so that no interference occurs when
a person uses a compatible phone and a compatible
hearing aid at the same time. This standard was
approved by the IEEE in 2000.
FDA continues to monitor the use of wireless phones
for possible interactions with other medical devices.
Should harmful interference be found to occur, FDA
will conduct testing to assess the interference and
work to resolve the problem.
Additional information on the safety of RF exposures
from various sources can be obtained from the
following organizations:
FCC RF Safety Program:
http://www.fcc.gov/oet/rfsafety/
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA):
http://www.epa.gov/radiation/
Occupational Safety and Health Administration's
(OSHA):
http://www.osha.gov/SLTC/
radiofrequencyradiation/index.html.
xlvii
National institute for Occupational Safety and
Health (NIOSH):
http://www.cdc.gov/niosh/emfpg.html
World health Organization (WHO):
http://www.who.int/peh-emf/
International Commission on Non-Ionizing
Radiation Protection:
http://www.icnirp.de
National Radiation Protection Board (UK):
http://www.nrpb.org.uk
Updated 4/3/2002: US food and Drug
Administration
http://www.fda.gov/cellphones
Road Safety
Your wireless phone gives you the powerful ability to
communicate by voice, almost anywhere, anytime.
But an important responsibility accompanies the
benefits of wireless phones, one that every user must
uphold.
When driving a car, driving is your first
responsibility. When using your wireless phone
behind the wheel of a car, practice good common
sense and remember the following tips:
1. Get to know your wireless phone and its features,
such as speed dial and redial. If available, these
features help you to place your call without taking
your attention off the road.
2. When available, use a hands-free device. If
possible, add an additional layer of convenience and
safety to your wireless phone with one of the many
hands free accessories available today.
3. Position your wireless phone within easy reach. Be
able to access your wireless phone without removing
your eyes from the road. If you get an incoming call
at an inconvenient time, let your voice mail answer it
for you.
4. Let the person you are speaking with know you are
driving; if necessary, suspend the call in heavy traffic
xlviii
or hazardous weather conditions. Rain, sleet, snow,
ice and even heavy traffic can be hazardous.
5. Do not take notes or look up phone numbers while
driving. Jotting down a “to do” list or flipping
through your address book takes attention away from
your primary responsibility, driving safely.
6.Dial sensibly and assess the traffic; if possible,
place calls when you are not moving or before
pulling into traffic. Try to plan calls when your car
will be stationary. If you need to make a call while
moving, dial only a few numbers, check the road and
your mirrors, then continue.
7.Do not engage in stressful or emotional
conversations that may be distracting. Make people
you are talking with aware you are driving and
suspend conversations that have the potential to
divert your attention from the road.
8.Use your wireless phone to call for help. Dial 9-1-1
or other local emergency number in the case of fire,
traffic accident or medical emergencies. Remember,
it is a free call on your wireless phone!
9.Use your wireless phone to help others in
emergencies. If you see an auto accident, crime in
progress or other serious emergency where lives are
in danger, call 9-1-1 or other local emergency
number, as you would want others to do for you.
10.Call roadside assistance or a special non-
emergency wireless assistance number when
necessary. If you see a broken-down vehicle posing
no serious hazard, a broken traffic signal, a minor
traffic accident where no one appears injured, or a
vehicle you know to be stolen, call roadside
assistance or other special non-emergency number.
“The wireless industry reminds you to
use your phone safely when driving.”
For more information, please call 1-888-901-SAFE,
or visit our web-site www.wow-com.com Provided
xlix
by the Cellular Telecommunications & Internet
Association
Operating Environment
Remember to follow any special regulations in force
in any area and always switch your phone off
whenever it is forbidden to use it, or when it may
cause interference or danger. When connecting the
phone or any accessory to another device, read its
user's guide for detailed safety instructions. Do not
connect incompatible products.
As with other mobile radio transmitting equipment,
users are advised that for the satisfactory operation of
the equipment and for the safety of personnel, it is
recommended that the equipment should only be
used in the normal operating position (held to your
ear with the antenna pointing over your shoulder).
Using Your Phone Near Other
Electronic Devices
Most modern electronic equipment is shielded from
radio frequency (RF) signals. However, certain
electronic equipment may not be shielded against the
RF signals from your wireless phone. Consult the
manufacturer to discuss alternatives.
Pacemakers
Pacemaker manufacturers recommend that a
minimum distance of 15 cm (6 inches) be maintained
between a wireless phone and a pacemaker to avoid
potential interference with the pacemaker.
These recommendations are consistent with the
independent research and recommendations of
Wireless Technology Research.
Persons with pacemakers:
should always keep the phone more than 15 cm (6
inches) from their pacemaker when the phone is
switched on.
should not carry the phone in a breast pocket.
l
should use the ear opposite the pacemaker to
minimize potential interference.
If you have any reason to suspect that interference is
taking place, switch your phone off immediately.
Hearing Aids
Some digital wireless phones may interfere with
some hearing aids. In the event of such interference,
you may wish to consult your hearing aid
manufacturer to discuss alternatives.
Other Medical Devices
If you use any other personal medical devices,
consult the manufacturer of your device to determine
if it is adequately shielded from external RF energy.
Your physician may be able to assist you in obtaining
this information. Switch your phone off in health
care facilities when any regulations posted in these
areas instruct you to do so. Hospitals or health care
facilities may be using equipment that could be
sensitive to external RF energy.
Vehicles
RF signals may affect improperly installed or
inadequately shielded electronic systems in motor
vehicles. Check with the manufacturer or its
representative regarding your vehicle. You should
also consult the manufacturer of any equipment that
has been added to your vehicle.
Posted Facilities
Switch your phone off in any facility where posted
notices require you to do so.
Potentially Explosive Environments
Switch your phone off when in any area with a
potentially explosive atmosphere and obey all signs
and instructions. Sparks in such areas could cause an
explosion or fire resulting in bodily injury or even
death.
Users are advised to switch the phone off while at a
refueling point (service station). Users are reminded
li
of the need to observe restrictions on the use of radio
equipment in fuel depots (fuel storage and
distribution areas), chemical plants or where blasting
operations are in progress.
Areas with a potentially explosive atmosphere are
often but not always clearly marked. They include
below deck on boats, chemical transfer or storage
facilities, vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas
(such as propane or butane), areas where the air
contains chemicals or particles, such as grain, dust or
metal powders, and any other area where you would
normally be advised to turn off your vehicle engine.
Emergency Calls
This phone, like any wireless phone, operates using
radio signals, wireless and landline networks as well
as user programmed functions, which cannot
guarantee connection in all conditions. Therefore,
you should never rely solely on any wireless phone
for essential communications (medical emergencies,
for example).
Remember, to make or receive any calls the phone
must be switched on and in a service area with
adequate signal strength. Emergency calls may not
be possible on all wireless phone networks or when
certain network services and/or phone features are in
use. Check with local service providers.
To make an emergency call:
1.If the phone is not on, switch it on.
2.Key in the emergency number for your present
location (for example, 911 or other official
emergency number). Emergency numbers vary by
location.
3.Press [Send]
If certain features are in use (call barring, for
example), you may first need to deactivate those
features before you can make an emergency call.
lii
Consult this document and your local cellular service
provider.
When making an emergency call, remember to give
all the necessary information as accurately as
possible. Remember that your phone may be the only
means of communication at the scene of an accident;
do not cut off the call until given permission to do so.
Restricting Children's access to your
Phone
Your phone is not a toy. Children should not be
allowed to play with it because they could hurt
themselves and others, damage the phone or make
calls that increase your phone bill.
FCC Notice and Cautions
FCC Notice
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC
Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful
interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that
may cause undesired operation.
This equipment has been tested and found to
comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,
pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits
are designed to provide reasonable protection
against harmful interference in a residential
installation. This equipment generates, uses and
can radiate radio frequency energy and,if not
installed and used in accordance with the
instructions, may cause harmful interference to
radio communications. However, there is no
guarantee that interference will not occur in a
particular installation. If this equipment does cause
harmful interference to radio or television
reception, which can be determined by turning the
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try
to correct the interference by one or more of the
following measures:
-Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
-Increase the separation between the equipment and
receiver.
liii
-Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit
different from that to which the receiver is
connected.
-Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV
technician for help
The phone may cause TV or radio interference if
used in close proximity to receiving equipment. The
FCC can require you to stop using the phone if such
interference cannot be eliminated.
Vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas (such as
propane or butane) must comply with the National
Fire Protection Standard (NFPA-58). For a copy of
this standard, contact the National Fire Protection
Association, One Battery march Park, Quincy, MA
02269, Attn: Publication Sales Division..
Cautions
Changes or modifications made in the radio phone,
not expressly approved by Samsung, will void the
user°Øs authority to operate the equipment.
Only use approved batteries, antennas and chargers.
The use of any unauthorized accessories may be
dangerous and void the phone warranty if said
accessories cause damage or a defect to the phone.
Although your phone is quite sturdy, it is a complex
piece of equipment and can be broken. Avoid
dropping, hitting, bending or sitting on it.
Other Important Safety Information.
Only qualified personnel should service the phone
or install the phone in a vehicle. Faulty installation
or service may be dangerous and may invalidate
any warranty applicable to the device.
Check regularly that all wireless phone equipment
in your vehicle is mounted and operating properly.
Do not store or carry flammable liquids, gases or
explosive materials in the same compartment as the
phone, its parts or accessories.
For vehicles equipped with an air bag, remember
that an air bag inflates with great force. Do not
place objects, including both installed or portable
wireless equipment in the area over the air bag or in
liv
the air bag deployment area. If wireless equipment
is improperly installed and the air bag inflates,
serious injury could result.
Switch your phone off before boarding an aircraft.
The use of wireless phone in aircraft is illegal and
may be dangerous to the aircraft's operation.
Failure to observe these instructions may lead to
the suspension or denial of telephone services to
the offender, or legal action, or both.
Product Performance
Getting the Most Out of Your Signal
Reception
The quality of each call you make or receive depends
on the signal strength in your area. Your phone
informs you of the current signal strength by
displaying a number of bars next to the signal
strength icon. The more bars displayed, the stronger
the signal.
If you're inside a building, being near a window may
give you better reception.
Understanding the Save Feature
If your phone is unable to find a signal after 15 minutes
of searching, a Power Save feature is automatically
activated. If your phone is active, it periodically rechecks
service availability or you can check it yourself
by pressing any key.
Anytime the Power Save feature is activated, a
message displays on the screen. When a signal is
found, your phone returns to standby mode.
Maintaining Your Phone's Peak
Performance
G
lv
For the best care of your phone, only authorized
personnel should service your phone and accessories.
Faulty service may void the warranty.
There are several simple guidelines to operating
your phone properly and maintaining safe,
satisfactory service.
Hold the phone with the antenna raised, fully-
extended and over your shoulder.
Try not to hold, bend or twist the phone's antenna.
Don't use the phone if the antenna is damaged.
Speak directly into the phone's receiver.
.Avoid exposing your phone and accessories to rain
or liquid spills. If your phone does get wet,
immediately turn the power off and remove the
battery. If it is inoperable, call Customer Care for
service.
Availability of Various Features/Ring
Tones
Many services and features are network dependent
and may require additional subscription and/or usage
charges. Not all features are available for purchase or
use in all areas. Downloadable Ring Tones may be
available at an additional cost. Other conditions and
restrictions may apply. See your service provider for
additional information.
Battery Standby and Talk Time
Standby and talk times will vary depending on phone
usage patterns and conditions. Battery power
consumption depends on factors such as network
configuration, signal strength, operating temperature,
features selected, frequency of calls, and voice, data,
and other application usage patterns.
Battery Precautions
Never use any charger or battery that is damaged in
any way.
Use the battery only for its intended purpose..If you
use the phone near the network's base station, it
uses less power; talk and standby time are greatly
affected by the signal strength on the cellular
network and the parameters set by the network
operator.
lvi
Battery charging time depends on the remaining
battery charge and the type of battery and charger
used. The battery can be charged and discharged
hundreds of times, but it will gradually wear out.
When the operation time (talk time and standby
time) is noticeably shorter than normal, it is time to
buy a new battery.
If left unused, a fully charged battery will discharge
itself over time.
Use only Samsung-approved batteries and recharge
your battery only with Samsung-approved
chargers. When a charger is not in use, disconnect
it from the power source. Do not leave the battery
connected to a charger for more than a week, since
overcharging may shorten its life.
Extreme temperatures will affect the charging
capacity of your battery: it may require cooling or
warming first.
Do not leave the battery in hot or cold places, such
as in a car in summer or winter conditions, as you
will reduce the capacity and lifetime of the battery.
Always try to keep the battery at room temperature.
A phone with a hot or cold battery may temporarily
not work, even when the battery is fully charged.
Li-ion batteries are particularly affected by
temperatures below 0 °C (32 °F).
Do not short-circuit the battery. Accidental short-
circuiting can occur when a metallic object (coin,
clip or pen) causes a direct connection between the
+ and - terminals of the battery (metal strips on the
battery), for example when you carry a spare
battery in a pocket or bag. Short-circuiting the
terminals may damage the battery or the object
causing the short-circuiting.
Dispose of used batteries in accordance with local
regulations. In some areas, the disposal of batteries
in household or business trash may be prohibited.
For safe disposal options for Li-Ion batteries,
contact your nearest Samsung authorized service
center. Always recycle. Do not dispose of batteries
in a fire.
Care and Maintenance
Your phone is a product of superior design and
craftsmanship and should be treated with care. The
suggestions below will help you fulfill any warranty
lvii
obligations and allow you to enjoy this product for
many years.
Keep the phone and all its parts and accessories out
of the reach of small children.
Keep the phone dry. Precipitation, humidity and
liquids contain minerals that will corrode electronic
circuits.
Do not use the phone with a wet hand. Doing so
may cause an electric shock to you or damage to
the phone.
Do not use or store the phone in dusty, dirty areas,
as its moving parts may be damaged.
Do not store the phone in hot areas. High
temperatures can shorten the life of electronic
devices, damage batteries, and warp or melt certain
plastics.
Do not store the phone in cold areas. When the
phone warms up to its normal operating
temperature, moisture can form inside the phone,
which may damage the phone's electronic circuit
boards.
Do not drop, knock or shake the phone. Rough
handling can break internal circuit boards.
Do not use harsh chemicals, cleaning solvents or
strong detergents to clean the phone. Wipe it with a
soft cloth slightly dampened in a mild soap-and-
water solution.
Do not paint the phone. Paint can clog the device's
moving parts and prevent proper operation.
Do not put the phone in or on heating devices, such
as a microwave oven, a stove or a radiator. The
phone may explode when overheated.
When the phone or battery gets wet, the label
indicating water damage inside the phone changes
color. In this case, phone repairs are no longer
guaranteed by the manufacturer's warranty, even if
the warranty for your phone has not expired.
If your phone has a flash or light, do not use it too
close to the eyes of people or animals. This may
cause damage to their eyes.
Use only the supplied or an approved replacement
antenna. Unauthorized antennas or modified
accessories may damage the phone and violate
regulations governing radio devices.
If the phone, battery, charger or any accessory is
not working properly, take it to your nearest
lviii
qualified service facility. The personnel there will
assist you, and if necessary, arrange for service.
Getting Started
1-2
Getting Started
1
USIM Card
General Information &
Precautions
Universal Subscriber Identity Module (USIM) Card
is an IC card containing customer and authentication
information, including handset number and limited
storage for Phonebook entries and SMS. Install
USIM Card to use 820SC; turn 820SC power off to
insert/remove USIM Card.
Insert USIM Card into another compatible handset to
access SMS and Phonebook entries saved on USIM
Card. Note the following precautions regarding
USIM Card usage and care (see USIM Card User
Guide for details):
Avoid using excessive force when Inserting/
removing USIM Card.
SoftBank is not liable for damages resulting from
inserting USIM Card into IC card readers or other
third party devices.
Always keep USIM Card IC chip clean.
Clean USIM Card IC chip with a soft, dry cloth.
Do not attach labels to USIM Card; malfunction
may result.
IC
USIM Card
1-3
Getting Started
1
1-4
Getting Started
1
Notes
USIM Card is the property of SoftBank.
If USIM Card is lost or damaged, you will be
charged for reissuing it.
Return USIM Card to SoftBank upon
termination of subscription.
Returned USIM Cards are recycled.
USIM Card specifications may change without
prior notice.
If USIM Card or 820SC with USIM Card
inserted is lost or stolen in Japan or abroad,
immediately contact Customer Service ( P.25-
25) to suspend service.
Handset/USIM Card repairs, replacement or
upgrades may deactivate Chaku-Uta
®
, Chaku-
Uta Full
®
,
S! Appli, or video files on handset.
Inserting another USIM Card (not the included
one) into 820SC may deactivate preinstalled S!
Appli or Comic Surfing files on handset.
Back-up USIM Card files. SoftBank is not liable
for lost files.
1-5
Getting Started
1
Inserting & Removing USIM
Card
Always turn power off before opening 820SC to
remove battery, or insert/remove USIM Card.
Inserting
ARemove battery ( P.1-17)
BWith IC chip down, insert USIM
Card into card slot
CPush in USIM Card until it stops and
locks
Removing
ARemove battery ( P.1-17)
BPress down on USIM Card and
gently slide it out
IC
1-6
Getting Started
1
USIM PINs
USIM Card features two (4- to 8-digit) security
codes:
PIN and PIN2.
PIN
Use PIN to prevent unauthorized use of 820SC by
others.
Modify PIN ( P.13-2).
When PIN lock is activated, PIN entry is required
each time 820SC is turned on or whenever USIM
Card is re-inserted ( P.13-3).
PIN2
PIN2 is required for Reset Call Cost or Edit Cost
Limit, etc.
Modify PIN2 ( P.13-2).
Note
Inserting USIM Card with excessive force may
damage it or 820SC.
Do not misplace a removed USIM Card.
To prevent damaging it, avoid touching the IC chip
when Inserting or removing USIM Card. Do not
touch battery contacts.
1-7
Getting Started
1
Canceling PIN Lock (PUK/PUK2
Code)
Incorrectly entering PIN or PIN2 three consecutive
times activates PIN Lock and limits 820SC function
access. Enter PUK (PIN Unlocking Key) Code to
cancel PIN Lock. For more information, contact
Customer Service ( P.25-25).
Note
Entering PUK or PUK2 incorrectly ten consecutive
times locks USIM Card and deactivates 820SC.
Write down PUK and PUK2.
Unlocking a locked USIM Card requires a special
procedure. Contact Customer Service ( P.25-25).
1-8
Getting Started
1
Handset Parts &
Functions
Handset
aEarpiece/
Speaker
bDisplay
cw
de
et
fC
g*
hRotating Camer
a
iudlr
jo
ki
lc
my
n0~9
o#
pMicrophone
qInternal
rSub Display
sn
tb
wBattery Cover
vCharger/External
Device
uStrap Eyelet
1-9
Getting Started
1
aEarpiece/Speaker
bDisplay
cLeft Softkey/Mail Key
Open Messaging menu or execute Left Softkey
command/function.
dCamera/Character Key
Activate Camera or select text entry mode.
eStart Key
Initiate and receive Voice Calls.
fClear/Back Key
Delete entered text or return to the previous window.
g Key
Enter line breaks in text entry windows.
In Standby, press for 1+ seconds to open Phone
Profiles.
hCamera
Capture images or send video during a Video Call.
iMulti Selector
Select menu items, move cursor, scroll window.
jRight Softkey/Yahoo! Keitai Key
Access Yahoo! Keitai or execute Right Softkey
command/function.
kSwitch Bar Key
Display Switch Bar ( P.1-26).
lCenter Key
Open Main Menu or execute Center Softkey command/
function.
mPower/End Key
Turn power on/off or end operations.
nKeypad
Enter numbers or characters and select menu items.
o#/Manner Key
Toggle Symbols menus in text entry windows.
In Standby, press for 1+ seconds to activate/cancel
Manner Profile.
pMicrophone
qInternal Antenna
rSub Display
sn(Side Key)
Raise volume. During a Video Call, enlarge image size.
1-10
Getting Started
1
tb(Side Key)
Lower volume. During a Video Call, reduce image size.
uStrap Eyelet
vCharger/External Device Port
Connect Charger, Stereo Earphone Microphone, USB
Cable, etc. here.
wBattery Cover
Opened to insert/remove battery or USIM Card.
Tip
Internal Antenna
820SC has no external antenna. 820SC transmits and
receives signals via Internal Antenna. Do not cover or
place stickers, etc. over the area containing Internal
Antenna. Voice quality may vary by where/how 820SC
is used.
1-11
Getting Started
1
Display Indicators
aSignal Strength (more bars indicate
stronger signal)
Out-of-Range (outside service area or no
signal when Language is set to English or
)
Out-of-Range (When Language is set to
)
b3G (UMTS) network connected/roaming
GSM network connected/roaming
Web SSL connected
c(Blue) Bluetooth® Active
(Flashing in Blue & Pink) Bluetooth®
Transmission
Bluetooth® Packet Data transmission
Call in Progress with Bluetooth® Active
(Blue) USB Connected
(Flashing in Orange & Yellow) USB Active
S! Appli Active
S! Appli Paused
Packet Data transmission
dVoice Call in Progress
Video Call in Progress
eNew S! Mail
New SMS
New Voice Mail
Unheard Answer Machine Message
Software Update Required
fNormal Profile
Manner Profile
abcdf
eg
i
h
日本語
1-12
Getting Started
1
Car Profile
Meeting Profile
Outdoor Profile
Offline Mode
gBattery Strong
Battery Moderate
Battery Low
(Flashing) Battery Weak (Charge Now)
hSound settings: Other than Off for Voice Call
in Ringtone volume Set; and On for Voice Call
in Vibration Set
Sound settings: Other than Off for Voice Call
in Ringtone volume Set; and Off for Voice Call
in Vibration Set
Sound settings: Off for Voice Call in Ringtone
volume Set; and On for Voice Call in Vibration
Set
Sound settings: Off for Voice Call in Ringtone
volume Set and Vibration Set
iRoaming Active
Voice Mail/Call Forwarding Active
Answer Machine Active
S! Mail Memory Full
SMS Memory Full
Voice Mail Memory Full
Wake-up Alarm/Alarm Set
Tip
When (Red) appears, only packet data
transmission and S! Mail sending are available;
Voice Call, received S! Mail notification, and SMS
sending/receiving are disabled.
1-13
Getting Started
1
Sub Display
a Signal Strength
(more bars indicate stronger signal)
b Wake-up Alarm/Alarm Set
c New Message
d Manner Profile Set; and On for Voice Call in
Vibration Set
e Battery Strong
Battery Moderate
Battery Low
Battery Weak (Charge Now)
Battery & Charger
Before Using Battery or
Charger
Charge battery before first use of 820SC or after
periods of disuse.
Charging Battery
Long periods of disuse may affect battery's ability
to hold a full charge.
820SC uses a lithium-ion battery; charge battery
in any state without damaging its ability to hold a
charge.
Do not charge battery under the following
conditions:
In ambient temperatures beyond 5°C - 40°C
In high levels of humidity, vibration or dust
Near a radio receiver (May cause feedback)
•820SC
or Charger may warm while charging. This
is normal, however, should they become very hot
a bcd e
1-14
Getting Started
1
to the touch, stop charging and contact Customer
Service ( P.25-25).
Charge battery at least once every six months
while not in use. Otherwise, battery may become
unusable.
Battery is a consumable; replace it if operating
time shortens noticeably.
Battery Life
Battery time/life may be reduced by any of the
following:
Environmental Factors
Storing/using 820SC beyond 5°C - 40°C
Using 820SC when signal is poor/out-of-range
Debris on 820SC, battery or Charger Port
Operational Factors
Active S! Appli
Camera use
Media Player use
Excessive Keypad use (e.g. for gaming or
messaging)
Bluetooth® transmissions
Frequently opening and closing 820SC
• Settings
Using Slide Show
Setting Brightness higher or Backlight Time
longer
Note
Use specified Charger only.
Battery must be inside 820SC to charge it.
When not in use, unplug Charger from outlet or
cigarette lighter socket.
1-15
Getting Started
1
Using Media Player with Backlight set to
Always on
Battery Disposal
Do not dispose of exhausted batteries with ordinary
refuse. Tape over battery terminals before disposal or
take to a SoftBank shop. Follow any and all local
regulations regarding battery disposal.
Lithium-ion batteries are recyclable.
1-16
Getting Started
1
When Battery Runs Out
When battery is weak, a warning appears and 820SC
beeps. Charge or replace battery; otherwise 820SC
will automatically turn off.
Inserting & Removing Battery
Inserting
APress Battery Cover and slide as
shown
BFully remove Battery Cover as shown
CAlign Battery Slots and 820SC Tabs
to insert battery as shown
a
b
820SC Tabs
1-17
Getting Started
1
DInsert Battery Cover Tabs into
820SC Slots to attach Battery Cover
as shown
Removing
Always turn 820SC off before removing battery.
Never remove battery while AC Charger or In-Car
Charger is connected.
APress Battery Cover and slide as
shown
BFully remove Battery Cover as shown
Note
Remove battery cover with care; stress on tabs may
damage them.
Gently insert battery to avoid damaging 820SC
tabs.
Battery Cover Tabs
a
b
1-18
Getting Started
1
CLift battery up and remove as shown
AC Charger
Use specified Charger only.
AOpen Port Cover and insert Charger
Connector into the port
BPlug Charger into an AC 100V outlet
CWhen battery is charged, unplug
Charger, then disconnect 820SC
Port Cover
Charger Connector
(with ٌ up)
Charge
AC 100V
1-19
Getting Started
1
Charging via PC USB Port
Battery will charge when 820SC is connected to a PC
via included USB cable.
aOpen Port Cover and insert USB Cable Connector
bInsert USB Connector into a PC USB port
cWhen battery is charged, remove Connector from
820SC and replace Port Cover, then remove USB
Connector from the PC USB port
Charging via USB takes more time; charging time will
vary by PC. A weak battery may not charge via a PC
USB port.
In-Car Charger (Optional)
AOpen Port Cover and insert
Connector Plug
BInsert Charger Connector into
lighter socket
Tip
Battery Charged Confirmation
If 820SC is on while Charger is connected, battery
indicators flash when battery is fully charged.
While charging, battery indicators change as follows:
ψψ. flashes when battery is fully
charged.
If 820SC is off while Charger is connected, battery
indicator and graphic appear full on Sub Display &
Battery full appears above graphic on Display when
battery is fully charged. Otherwise, Charging...
appears above animation on Display.
•Charging Time
An empty battery requires 120 minutes (approx.) to
charge when power on and Display off (no operation).
Longer when Display on. Charging time may vary by
ambient temperature.
Port Cover
Charger
Connector
(with ٌ up)
1-20
Getting Started
1
CStart the car's engine
DWhen battery is charged, disconnect
handset (replace Port Cover), then
unplug In-Car Charger
Power On/Off
Power On
AOpen 820SC
BPress y for 1+ seconds
In-Car
Charger
Lighter Socket Tip
Battery Charged Confirmation ( P.1-19)
Charging Time ( P.1-19)
When using In-Car Charger
See In-Car Charger manual. For safety, use In-Car
Holder together with In-Car Charger.
Note
Do not charge battery in ambient temperatures
over 40°C (e.g. inside a closed automobile in direct
sunlight, etc.).
Use In-Car Charger in cars with a negative earth
only (DC 12/24V).
1-21
Getting Started
1
Power Off
APress y for 2+ seconds
Time & Date
Time & Date
Some 820SC functions cannot be used unless time
and date are set. Open Time & Date to change Time
Format or Date Format.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Time & date
BAdjust settings
To set time
Tip
To confirm handset phone number
In Standby, press c ψ 0; save or edit your information
in My Phonebook Details including name and mail
address ( P.5-16).
When PIN lock is activated
PIN entry is required each time 820SC is turned on.
When 820SC is left open without operations ( P.8-
7)
Display automatically shuts down to conserve power.
Note
Use both hands to open and close 820SC; avoid
using excessive force which could damage handset
or lead to malfunctions.
Standby
Default
Setting
عTime format: 24H
عDate format: YYYY/MM/DD
1-22
Getting Started
1
Highlight Time field and enter the time (24-hour
format)
To set AM/PM (for 12-hour format)
aHighlight Time field and press r twice for
AM/PM option
bUse r to toggle AM and PM
To set date
Highlight Date field and enter year, month, and
day
To change time format
aSelect Time format field
bSelect the setting and press c
To change date format
aSelect Date format field
bSelect the setting and press c
CPress w (Save)
Time Zone Updating
Automatically update 820SC Date & Time using
server time zone information.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Time & date
BSelect Time zone updating and
perform operations to set
CPress w (Save)
Default
Setting
عPrompt first
Tip
1-23
Getting Started
1
Changing Home Time Zone
Select the zone closest to your locality. Set Daylight
saving time as required. Complete this setting before
selecting Dual Clock in Clock Display ( P.8-4).
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Time & date
BSelect Home zone field
CSet time zone
To set home time zone
aUse s to specify a target area
bPress c
To set daylight saving time
aCheck Daylight saving
bPress w (OK)
Time zone updating Items
Manual only: Enter date & time manually.
Prompt first: Confirmation appears when 820SC
moves into a different time zone. This function is not
available Japan.
Automatic: Time & Date updated according to server
time zone information. This function is not available
Japan.
Default
Setting
عHome zone: GMT+9h
عDaylight saving: Unchecked
1-24
Getting Started
1
DPress w (Save) 820SC Menus
Main Menu
AIn Standby, press c
BHighlight an item and press c(Select)
Main Menu
1-25
Getting Started
1
CRepeat Step 2 to open/activate the
target function
<Example> Select Display settings ψWallpaper
When Popup Menu ( P.8-6) is On
Content is different (Step 2), however operations
remain the same.
Selecting items with Keypad
When numbered items appear in menus, etc., use
keypad to select them.
Select Display
settings
Select Settings
Select Wallpaper
Pictures
Wallpaper Setup
Window appears
Tip
To end an operation
Press y. Operation ends and 820SC returns to Standby.
When multiple functions are active, the next active
operation window appears.
To cancel/escape an operation
Press y. Operation/function is canceled and 820SC
returns to Standby or the previous window appears. For
some menus, a confirmation appears.
Menu operations ( P.xiv)
1-26
Getting Started
1
Shortcuts
In Standby, press a key to open the assigned shortcut.
* Create shortcuts for frequently used functions in Idle
shortcut ( P.15-7).
Switch Bar
Initiate Call,Messaging,Yahoo! Keitai, or Media
Player; use multiple functions concurrently (e.g.,
create a message while listening to music, or browse
the Mobile Internet while talking on the phone).
AIn Standby or an active function
window, press i
BUse s to highlight a function and
press c (Select)
To exit an active function
From the window of the function to exit, press y
Key Corresponding Menu/Function
wMessaging
oYahoo! Keitai Main Menu
o
(1+ seconds) Yahoo! Keitai Menu
eMobile Camera (last used function)
iSwitch Bar
uIdle shortcut*
dPhonebook list
lCall Log (Received)
rCall Log (Dialled)
tCall Log (Current Contacts)
*
(1+ seconds) Phone Profiles
#
(1+ seconds) Activate/Cancel Manner Profile
1-27
Getting Started
1
To exit all active functions
aPress i
bUse s to highlight End all? and press c (Yes)
Options
When Options appears at bottom-right of Display,
press o to open Options. To execute an option,
highlight the item and press c (Select).
Security Codes
Phone Password, Center Access Code and Network
Password are required to use 820SC.
Phone Password
The 4-digit number (9999 by default) required to use/
change some handset functions.
Entered digits are represented with*
If incorrect, an error message appears; try again.
Change Phone Password as required
Center Access Code
4-digit number specified at subscription; required to
access Voice Mail via landlines/to subscribe to fee-
based information.
Center Access Code cannot be changed on 820SC; a
special procedure is required. For details, contact
Customer Service ( P.25-25).
Tip
When exiting all active functions
Exiting all active functions during message creation or
voice/video recording deletes created/recorded data.
Tip
See "Options" ( P.xiv)
1-28
Getting Started
1
Network Password
4-digit number specified at subscription, required to
restrict handset services. Entering Network Password
incorrectly three consecutive times locks Call
Barring settings. To resolve, Network Password and
Center Access Code must be changed. For details,
contact Customer Service ( P.25-25).
Network Password can be changed on 820SC
(P.16-13).
Note
Write down Phone Password, Center Access Code,
or Network Password. If you forget any of these
codes contact Customer Service ( P.25-25).
Do not reveal Phone Password, Center Access
Code, or Network Password to others. SoftBank is
not liable for damages caused by misuse of these
codes by others.
Basic Handset Operations
2-2
Basic Handset Operations
2
Initiating a Call
See P.5-9 to call from a Phonebook entry or P.6-2 for
Video Calls.
AEnter a phone number
When Phonebook list appears ( P.5-11)
To use Speed Dialing ( P.5-12)
BConfirm the number and press t
CPress y to end the call
Placing international calls from Japan
A separate subscription is required for international
calls.
aEnter a phone number
bOptions ψInternational dial
cSelect country or Enter Code for direct entry
dSelect Japan
eConfirm the number and press t
Using a SoftBank handset overseas
Enter handset phone number; country code is not
required.
Calling from overseas ( P.2-15)
Tip
To correct entered digits
Press C to delete the last digit. Press C for 1+ seconds
to delete all.
When the line is busy
Press y to end the call and try again later. If Auto
Redial ( P.15-2) is active, number is automatically
redialed. Press o (Cancel) or y to cancel.
When Stereo Earphone Microphone is connected
Enter a number and press Stereo Earphone Microphone
switch for 1+ seconds to initiate a call. When
Earphone call is On, press switch for 1+ seconds to
call specified number. Press switch for 1+ seconds to
end a call.
Engaged Call Operations ( P.2-7)
2-3
Basic Handset Operations
2
Options Receiving a Call
AWhen 820SC rings/vibrates, press t
or c (Accept)
BPress y to end the call
Item Description
Video call Initiate a Video Call ( P.6-2).
Add to
Phonebook
Save a number to Phonebook or
USIM Card Phonebook ( P.5-6).
Create msg Open a new message addressed to
the number ( P.17-6).
Phonebook Open Phonebook Search window.
Call log Open Call Log.
International dial
Add international code and
country code to a number ( P.2-
2).
Hide/Show my ID
Hide or show your phone number
when placing calls; select None to
apply Caller ID ( P.16-13)
settings.
Tip
When Anykey Answer ( P.15-5) is On
Press any key except w, o, y, or Side Key n b to answer
Voice Calls.
To mute ringer for an incoming call
While 820SC rings/vibrates, press w (Mute); caller
continues to hear ringback tone. To answer the call,
press c (Accept).
To adjust ringer volume
While 820SC rings/vibrates, press Side Key n or b.
When Stereo Earphone Microphone is connected
When 820SC rings/vibrates, press Stereo Earphone
Microphone switch for 1+ seconds to accept a call.
Press again for 1+ seconds to end the call.
Engaged Call Operations ( P.2-7)
2-4
Basic Handset Operations
2
Ringtones
Specify ringtones for saved numbers by Phonebook
entry or Category ( P.5-4, 5-7). When no ringtone is
set, 820SC rings according to Profile Settings ( P.9-2).
Under following conditions, 820SC rings according to
each Mode; Secret Mode is set to Hide and
Phonebook(contains caller's number as an entry)'s
Secret Mode is set to On.
Incoming call window
If caller sends Caller ID, phone number appears; if
saved in Phonebook, name appears. When an image is
set in Phonebook or Category, image also appears
( P.5-4, 5-7). If caller hides Caller ID, Withheld
appears.
Under following conditions, no name/image appears;
Secret Mode is set to Hide and Phonebook(contains
caller's number as an entry)'s Secret Mode is set to On.
Missed call window
After an unanswered incoming call, Missed call
window appears. Press w (View), to open Missed Call
Log ( P.2-9).
When you cannot answer a call
Use Call Forwarding/Voice Mail to forward incoming
calls to a specified number automatically/to save
messages at Voice Mail Center. When Call Forwarding
or Voice Mail is set to No reply, press o (Busy) to
forward an incoming call immediately ( P.16-3, 16-5).
Use Answer Machine to record caller messages. Up to 3
messages (15 seconds per message) can be recorded in
820SC ( P.2-5).
Reject Incoming Call
Proactively disconnect an incoming call without
answering it. The rejected call is recorded in Missed.
AWhile 820SC rings/vibrates, press y
2-5
Basic Handset Operations
2
Answer Machine
Record caller messages on handset. Up to 3 messages
(15 seconds per message) can be recorded.
Activating & Canceling
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Answer machine Setting
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
With Answer Machine set
In Standby, appears.
Tip
When Side Key ( P.15-6) is set to Reject
Press n or b for 1+ seconds to reject an incoming call.
To reject call and send a busy message
When neither Call Forwarding ( P.16-2) nor Voice
Mail ( P.16-2) is active, press o (Busy) to proactively
disconnect a call without answering it; "busy" message
appears on caller's handset before call is disconnected.
If caller's handset is incompatible, call is simply
disconnected.
To automatically reject a call ( P.13-8)
Default
Setting
عOff
Note
Answer Machine cannot be used when handset is
off, out-of-range or in Offline mode. Use Voice Mail
to record caller messages.
If 820SC shared memory ( P.25-15) is below
600 KB, Answer Machine cannot be used.
2-6
Basic Handset Operations
2
Ringing Duration
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Answer machine
Ringing duration
BSelect an item or Other (0-60Secs) to
set a time
CPress c (Save)
Sound Language
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Answer machine Sound
language
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Checking Recordings
When Answer Machine records caller messages,
appears in Display.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Answer machine
Recordings
BHighlight the message to check and
press c (Play)
Default
Setting
ع18 seconds
Default
Setting
عᣣᧄ⺆
Tip
To delete messages
Highlight the message to delete, press w (Delete) and
select Yes.
2-7
Basic Handset Operations
2
Engaged Call Operations
Earpiece Volume
Adjust Earpiece or Earphone volume. Setting
remains even after power off.
ADuring a call, press Side Key nb or j
Hold
When a call is put on hold, the party on hold hears a
hold tone and neither party can hear the others
voice.
A subscription to Call Waiting ( P.16-8) or
Conference Call ( P.16-9) is required to use this
function. If you have not subscribed to any of these
services, Hold function is not available.
ADuring a call, press w (Hold)
BPress w (Retrieve) to reconnect the
call
Speaker Phone
ADuring a call, press c ( ) and select
Yes
To cancel Speaker Phone
Press c ( )
Voice Recording
Record voice of a maximum of 2 minutes during a
call.
ADuring a call, select Options
Record
BPress c (Record)
2-8
Basic Handset Operations
2
CStop or pause
To stop and save
Press w (Stop)
To pause and save
aPress c (Pause)
bPress c (Record) to restart recording; press w
(Save) to end recording
Engaged Call Options
Tip
When a recording is made
Files are saved to Sounds & Ringtones folder in Data
Folder.
When another call arrives while recording
If Call Waiting is subscribed, recording stops and
incoming call window appears.
When call is ended while recording
Recording stops automatically and voice file is saved.
Item Description
Whisper on/off With On, raise the volume of sent
sounds.
Mute
Check Voice or Key tone and press
w (OK) to cancel sending no sounds
or key tones.
New call
Enter a number and press c (Call) to
initiate another call; requires
subscription to Conference Call
( P.16-9).
Phonebook Open Phonebook Search window.
Add to
Phonebook
Save number to Phonebook or USIM
Card Phonebook ( P.5-6).
Create msg Open a new message addressed to the
number ( P.17-6).
Send DTMF Enter digits then press c (Send).
Record Record caller's voice during a call
( P.2-7).
Memo Create and save text memos ( P.14-
10).
2-9
Basic Handset Operations
2
Call Log Records
Viewing Call Log Records
APress r
BUse s to select a Call Log
To confirm phone number and call duration
Highlight an item and press c (View)
Call Log Record Indicators
: Voice Call to/from a number
saved in Phonebook
: Call to/from a number saved in USIM Card
Phonebook
: Voice Call to/from an unsaved number
: Video Call to/from a number saved in Phonebook
Current Contacts (all incoming/outgoing calls)
Indicators
: Received call : Rejected incoming call
: Missed call : Dialled call
Calling from Call Log Records
APress r
BUse s to select a Call Log
End call Disconnect call.
Switch to
headset/Switch
to phone
Appears when Bluetooth®-compatible
headset is in use. Select headset or
phone (handset).
Current
contacts All incoming and outgoing calls
Missed All missed incoming calls
Received All received incoming calls
Dialled All outgoing calls
Item Description
Tip
While Secret Mode is set to Hide
Call Log records of numbers saved in Secret
Phonebook entries do not appear.
2-10
Basic Handset Operations
2
CHighlight a record and press t
To initiate a Video Call
Options ψVideo call
Deleting Call Log Records
Deleting One Record
Delete one Call Log record.
APress r
BUse s to select a Call Log
CHighlight a record, select Options
Delete Selected Yes
Deleting All Records
Delete all Call Log records at once.
APress r
Use s to select Current contacts
BSelect Options Delete All Yes
CEnter Phone Password and press
c (Confirm)
Call Log Options
Tip
To delete individual calls from records
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bHighlight a record and press c (View)
cHighlight a call, select Options ψDelete ψ
Selected ψYes
Item Description
Voice call Initiate a Voice Call to the current
number.
Video call Initiate a Video Call to the current
number ( P.2-9).
Add to
Phonebook
Save number to Phonebook or USIM
Card Phonebook ( P.5-6).
Create msg Open a new message addressed to the
current number ( P.17-6).
2-11
Basic Handset Operations
2
Call Manager
Data Counter, Call Costs, &
Call Times
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Call manager
BSelect an item
To reset a Data Counter item
aIn Data counter, highlight an item, select
Options ψReset
bSelect Yes
To reset all Data Counter items
aIn Data counter, highlight an item, select
Options ψReset all
bEnter Phone Password and press c (Confirm),
and select Yes
To reset Call Costs
aIn Call costs, select Options ψReset call
cost
bEnter PIN2 and press c (Confirm)
Delete Delete the current Call Log record
( P.2-10).
Add to black list Add the number to Black List
( P.13-9).
View phonebook
details Open Entry details for a number.
International dial Add international code and country
code to the number ( P.2-2).
Hide/Show my
ID
Hide or show your phone number
when placing calls; select None to
apply Caller ID settings.
Data counter Confirm/reset incoming/outgoing data
volume.
Call costs
Confirm/reset Total Costs, Last Call
Cost or Cost Limit; change Call Costs
currency unit.
Call times Confirm/reset incoming/outgoing
Voice/Video Call Times.
Item Description
2-12
Basic Handset Operations
2
To reset Call Times
aIn Call times, highlight an item, select
Options ψReset ψYes
To reset all Call Times
aIn Call times, highlight an item, select
Options ψReset all
bEnter Phone Password and press c (Confirm)
ψYes
To change Call Costs currency unit
aIn Call costs, select Options ψSetup
currency
bEnter PIN2 and press c (Confirm)
cHighlight Price field to enter a price in Yen
dHighlight Currency field and enter currency
unit
ePress w (Save)
Edit Cost Limit
After reaching the call cost limit, only emergency
calls ( P.2-16) can be initiated; messaging, web
connections (fee-based operations) are disabled.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Call manager
BSelect Call costs
CSelect Options Edit cost limit
DEnter PIN2 and press c (Confirm)
EEnter limit
2-13
Basic Handset Operations
2
Display Call Cost during a Call
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Call manager Display
call cost
BSelect setting and press c (Save)
International Roaming
A separate subscription is required for international
calls. Contact Customer Service for more
information about international roaming.
Changing Network Mode
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Network mode
BSelect a Network mode
Default
Setting
عOff
Default
Setting
ع3G
Tip
Network mode Items
Automatic: Network is set automatically by location.
GSM 900/1800: Available overseas.
GSM 1900: Available overseas.
3G: Available domestically and overseas.
2-14
Basic Handset Operations
2
Network Setup
Selecting a Network
Select a network (operator) by location or use
Automatic.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Network selection
BSelect a Network
To select automatically
Select Automatic
To select a specific network
aSelect Manual
bSelect a network
Preferred Networks
Insert networks into Preferred Networks list or add
them to the end. Select networks from Network List
or create new network entries.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Preferred networks
BEdit Preferred Networks
To insert/add a network from Network List
aWhen inserting, highlight insert position
bOptions ψInsert or Add ψNetwork list
cSelect a network and press c (Insert/Add)
To insert/add a new network
aWhen inserting, highlight insert position
bOptions ψInsert or Add ψNew network
cEnter network settings and press w (Insert/
Add)
To delete a network from Preferred
Networks
Default
Setting
عAutomatic
2-15
Basic Handset Operations
2
Highlight network to delete, select Options ψ
Delete ψYes
Calling from Outside Japan
AEnter phone number with area code
To call an in-country landline or mobile
phone
Proceed to Step 5
To enter country code, etc. directly
Press 0 for 1+ seconds to enter +, enter country
code and phone number omitting the first 0
(except when calling landlines in Italy) and
proceed to Step 5
Tip
New Network Settings
Country code Up to 3 digits
Network code Up to 3 digits
Network name Up to 20 single-byte alphanumerics
Network type GSM or 3G
2-16
Basic Handset Operations
2
BSelect Options International dial
CSelect country or Enter Code for
direct entry
DSelect Abroad
EConfirm number and press t
Emergency Calls
Some emergency numbers (110 (Police), 119 (Fire),
etc.) are available even when certain Call Barring
settings are active. See details below.
Tip
To change/add International code or country code
( P.15-2)
820SC Status Available Numbers
Offline mode ( P.3-4) is active. None
Call Cost limit exceeded ( P.2-
12). 110, 119, 118
820SC is locked ( P.13-5). None
Required PIN not entered ( P.13-
3). None
USIM Card cannot be
authenticated ( P.13-4). None
Outgoing Call Barring ( P.16-11)
is active. 110, 119, 118
Note
SoftBank can not guarantee connections in all
countries and regions. Handset operations may
vary by network, signal, or function settings.
Manner Profile
3-2
Manner Profile
3
Minding Mobile Manners
Please take care not to disturb others when using
820SC.
Turn 820SC off in theaters, museums, and other
places where silence is the norm.
Keep 820SC off aboard airplanes, inside hospitals,
or in other places where handset use is prohibited.
Refrain from using 820SC in places such as
restaurants, hotel lobbies, or elevators.
Observe announcements or posted instructions
regarding handset use aboard trains, etc.
Refrain from handset use that interrupts the flow of
pedestrian or vehicle traffic.
Manner Related Functions
820SC offers two manner-related profiles.
Manner Profile
Silence 820SC sounds and activate Vibration for all
alerts, tones, and alarms. Use Manner Key to activate
or cancel Manner Profile.
Offline Mode
Temporarily suspend 820SC transmissions; other
820SC functions may still be used while Offline
Mode is active.
Muting/vibrating 820SC can be selected respectively
for alert tone, ringtone, or alarm in Sound settings
other than Manner Profile/Offline Mode.
3-3
Manner Profile
3
Manner Profile
AIn Standby, press # for 1+ seconds
Changing Profile
820SC features five Profiles, including Manner
Profile.
AIn Standby, press * for 1+ seconds
BSelect a Profile
CPress c (Save)
Profiles
Select a Profile by usage and edit settings as required
(P.9-2).
Tip
When Manner Profile is active
appears.
Even when Manner Profile is active, shutter click
sounds for Camera.
Tip
To change 820SC Profile ( P.9-2)
Profile Description
Normal Normal sounds produced by 820SC
Manner No sounds produced by 820SC
Car
Set Automatic reception of Voice
Calls and activation of Speaker
Phone for use while driving
Meeting Ringtone or Key tone preset to
Vibration or Mute
Outdoor Ringtone or Key tone preset to
maximum sound volume
3-4
Manner Profile
3
Offline Mode
APress c and select SettingsCall
settings Offline mode
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
When 820SC is turned off while Offline mode is
active
Offline mode activation confirmation appears the next
time 820SC is turned on. Press o (No) to select Normal
Profile.
Entering Text
4-2
Entering Text
4
Text Entry
Enter kanji/hiragana/hangul, single- or double-byte
katakana, alphanumerics, or symbols/pictograms/
emoticons.
Text Entry Window
*Suggestions appear only in Kanji/Hiragana mode, when
Prediction setting is On.
Number Only Text Entry Fields
Text entry windows do not appear for Phonebook Phone
fields or Alarm Time fields; enter numbers directly.
Changing Text Entry Mode
Text Entry modes may be limited in some text entry
fields or windows.
AIn a text entry window, press e
BHighlight entry mode and press c
Current Entry Mode
: Kanji/Hiragana
: Double-byte Katakana
: Double-byte
Alphanumerics
: Double-byte Numbers
: Double-byte Symbols
: Pictograms : Emoticons
: Hangul
Number of characters that still can be entered
Text entry field
: Single-byte
Alphanumerics
: Single-byte Kataka
n
: Single-byte
: Single-byte
Text entry field
Suggestions*
Japanese kana conversion alternatives
Tip
To toggle symbols
In text entry windows, press # to toggle Symbols,
Pictograms, and Emoticons.
4-3
Entering Text
4
Key Assignments
Multiple characters are assigned to each key. Press a key repeatedly until the target character appears.
1 When double-byte, "~" cannot be used (""appears on Display).2 Single-byte "" (lower case) cannot be entered.
Key Kanji/Hiragana Katakana Alphanumerics Numbers
1޽޿߁߃߅޼޾߀߂߄  ࠕࠗ࠙ࠛࠝࠔࠖ࠘ࠚࠜ  "A`1
2߆߈ߊߌߎ ࠞࠠࠢࠤࠦ CDE#$%
3ߐߒߔߖߘ ࠨࠪࠬ࠮࠰ FGH&'(
4ߚߜߟߡߣߞ  ࠲࠴࠷࠹࠻࠶  IJK)*+
5ߥߦߧߨߩ ࠽࠾࠿ࡀࡁ LMN,-.
6ߪ߭߰߳߶ ࡂࡅࡈࡋࡎ OPQ/01
7߹ߺ߻߼߽ ࡑࡒࡓࡔࡕ RSTU2345
8߿ࠁࠃ߾ࠀࠂ  ࡗ࡙࡛ࡖࡘ࡚  VWX678
9ࠄࠅࠆࠇࠈ ࡜࡝࡞࡟ࡠ YZ[\9:;<
0ࠊࠍࠎࠉޔޕ㧙࡮㨪㧍㧫
ޛ5RCEGޜ
ࡢࡥࡦࡡ 2ޔޕ㧙࡮㨪㧍㧫
ޛ5RCEGޜ A!ޛ5RCEGޜ 
*
Toggle upper/lower-case; add /to unfixed,
convertible kana
Enter Line Break
Toggle upper/lower-
case
Enter Line Break
Enter Line Break
#
Reverse toggle characters assigned to the same key before finalizing character
selection
Toggle Pictograms, Double-byte Symbols, Single-byte Symbols, Emoticons
Toggle Pictograms,
Double-byte Symbols,
Single-byte Symbols,
Emoticons
4-4
Entering Text
4
When calls/alarms interrupt text entry
Answer incoming calls without saving text first;
disconnect call to return to text entry window. Similarly,
close Alarm window to return to text entry window.
Entering Characters
Hiragana/Kanji
Enter hiragana/kanji with or without conversion
predictions. When Prediction setting is On,
Suggestions appear below text entry window.
AActivate Kanji/Kana entry mode to
enter hiragana
To ad d or
Enter a valid character and press *
To correct a misentry
Use C to delete the character then enter the
correction
When key is pressed too many times
Press # to return to the previous character
assigned to the same key
To enter consecutive characters assigned to
the same key
Press r to move cursor to the right
To enter unconverted hiragana
Press c (Confirm)
4-5
Entering Text
4
BConvert hiragana
To select a conversion from Suggestions
aPress d to move between Suggestions
bHighlight a conversion and press c (Confirm)
When target conversion does not appear
aPress w (Convert)
bUse s to change the conversion range
cPress d to move to Suggestions
dHighlight a conversion and press c (Confirm)
eRepeat steps b through d as required
Tip
When characters do not convert to target Kanji
Try entering different readings. When multiple Kanji
do not convert together, try to convert them separately.
To toggle predicted/conversion alternatives
While predicted alternatives appear, press w (Convert)
for conversion alternatives. While conversion
alternatives appear, press w (Predict) for predicted
alternatives.
To set/release prediction entry function ( P.4-13)
To convert using User dictionary ( P.4-14)
To enter date/time
aPress a key to enter a key to which numbers are
assigned
bPress o (EngNum㩀㩏)
cHighlight a conversion alternative and press c
(Confirm)
4-6
Entering Text
4
Resetting Text Entry History
Previous kanji conversions appear first for predicted/
conversion alternatives. Follow these steps to restore
defaults.
aPress c and select Settings ψPhone settings ψUser
dictionary ψReset learning
bEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) ψYes
Katakana
AIn Katakana mode, press a key to
enter the assigned character
To add or
Enter a Katakana to which a voiced or semi-
voiced sound symbol should be added and press
*
To correct a misentry
Use C to delete character then correct
When key is pressed too many times
Press # to return to the previous character
assigned to the same key
To enter consecutive characters assigned to
the same key
Press r to move cursor to the right
4-7
Entering Text
4
Alphanumerics
AIn Alphanumerics entry mode, press
a key to enter the assigned character
To toggle upper and lower case
Enter a character and press *
To correct a misentry
Use C to delete the character and press the
correct key
When key is pressed too many times
Press # to return to a previous character
assigned to the same key
Tip
To enter Katakana in Kanji/Kana entry mode
For example, to convert "ߊ߽" to "ࠢࡕ" or "㩂㩝".
aIn Kanji/Kana entry mode, enter hiragana
bPress o (EngNum㩀㩏)
cHighlight katakana conversion alternative and press
c (Confirm)
4-8
Entering Text
4
To enter consecutive characters assigned to
the same key
Press r to move cursor to the right
Numbers
AIn Number entry mode, press
number keys
To correct a misentry
Use C to delete the entry, then enter correction
Tip
To enter alphanumerics in Kanji/Kana entry mode
Press key(s) assigned to alphanumerics as many times
as it would take to enter same character(s) in
Alphanumerics mode. For example, press 2 three times
and press 3 once to enter "cd."
aIn Kanji/Kana entry mode, press key to which
alphanumeric is assigned
bPress o (EngNum㩀㩏)
cHighlight alphanumeric conversion alternative and
press c (Confirm)
Tip
To enter numbers in Kanji/Kana entry mode
aIn Kanji/Kana entry mode, press key to which
number is assigned
bPress o (EngNum㩀㩏)
cHighlight number conversion alternative and press
c (Confirm)
4-9
Entering Text
4
Symbols, Pictograms &
Emoticons
AIn a text entry window, press # to
toggle symbols
To toggle double-byte symbols and single-
byte symbols
Press * while Suggestions for double-byte
symbols and single-byte symbols appear
BHighlight target character and press
c
To enter symbols, pictograms, or emoticons
successively
Press w (Continue)
Tip
To enter symbols, pictograms, or emoticons in
Kanji/Kana entry mode
Enter hiragana like
ߡࠎ
and press w (Convert),
symbols
and
̖
appear among conversion alternatives.
Similarly, convert
ߪ࡯ߣ
or
ߢࠎࠊ
to pictograms and
ࠊ࡯޿
or
߃࡯ࠎ
to emoticons.
4-10
Entering Text
4
Line Breaks
Enter a line break the same way in all text entry
modes.
AIn a text entry window, press *
Quoting Saved Text
Using Phonebook Entries
In a text entry window, use Phonebook via Options to
search saved entries for inserting phone numbers or
mail addresses into message text.
AIn message text, select Options
Phonebook
BSelect an entry and open details
CHighlight an item and press c (Select)
SMS Template
In a text entry window, use SMS template via Options
to quote saved text in SMS.
Save frequently used words/phrases as SMS
templates beforehand ( P.4-15).
AIn message text, select Options
SMS template
BSelect a template
Using Template
In a text entry window, use Templates via Options to
save ".ne.jp" or "http://www" in Phonebook for one
keystroke entry.
AIn message text, select Options
Templates
BSelect an item
4-11
Entering Text
4
Hangul
Select Hangul entry mode to enter Hangul characters.
AIn a text entry window, press e and
select Hangul
BPress number keys to enter assigned
character units that appear; combine
several consonants and vowels
Editing Text
Deleting
AHighlight character to delete and
press C
When a space is highlighted
The character before cursor is deleted.
To delete all text on/after cursor
Press C for 1+ seconds
To delete all text
Place cursor at the end of text and press C for 1+
seconds
Consonant Example (Key Assignment)
4 (once) 4 (twice) 4
(three times)
Vowel Example (Key Assignment)
01 (), 2 () 0122
02 (), 1 () 0221
02 (), 3 () 0223
02 (), 3 (), 1 ( ), 2 (), 1 ()
4-12
Entering Text
4
Copy/Cut, Paste & Undo
Copy/Cut
Select a range of characters to copy/cut. Paste
copied/cut characters repeatedly to other locations.
AIn a text entry window, select Options
Copy or Cut
BUse a to highlight the first character
in the range and press
c (Start)
To copy/cut all
Press o (All)
CUse a to specify range and press
c (End)
Paste
AUse a to move cursor to paste location
BSelect Options Paste
CSelect an item to paste and press
c (Select)
Tip
To copy text from Phonebook entries or My
Phonebook Details
Options ψCopy item ( P.5-13, 5-17)
Copied/cut items
Up to 10 copied/cut items can be saved. Content
remains even power is turned off. With 10 items are
already saved, oldest item is automatically deleted.
4-13
Entering Text
4
Undo
Undo operations immediately after performing such
as Cut, Paste, or Delete. Alternatively, undo
converting operations immediately after character
conversion; this operation can be performed in Kanji/
Kana entry mode only.
AIn a text entry window, select Options
Undo
Jump
AIn a text entry window, select Options
Jump Top or End
Prediction (Japanese)
Select to show/hide Japanese kana conversion
alternatives in Suggestions.
AIn a text entry window, select Options
Prediction On or Prediction Off
Learning (Japanese)
Select to save/discard entered character strings by
Suggestions.
AIn a text entry window, select Options
Learning On or Learning Off
Tip
To delete copied/cut items
In Step 3, highlight item to delete, press w (Delete) and
select Yes
.
Default
Setting
عOn
Default
Setting
عOn
4-14
Entering Text
4
Font Size
Change font size for SMS, S! Mail, or template text;
available sizes vary.
AIn message text, select Options
Font Size
User Dictionary
(Japanese)
Save frequently used words/phrases of up to 20
characters; entries appear in Suggestions when key
characters are entered.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings User dictionary New
entry
BSelect Word field and enter text
CSelect Reading field and enter key
characters
DPress w (Save)
Default
Setting
عLarge
Tip
To edit User Dictionary entries
aPress c and select Settings ψPhone settings ψ
User dictionary ψEdit entry
bSelect contents to edit
cEdit a word or readings and press w (Save)
To delete one item
aPress c and select Settings ψPhone settings ψ
User dictionary ψEdit entry
bHighlight item to delete, select Options ψDelete
To delete all items
aPress c and select Settings ψPhone settings ψ
User dictionary ψDelete all
bEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) ψYes
4-15
Entering Text
4
Saving to User Dictionary
AIn a text entry window, select Options
Word registration
BUse a to move cursor to the first
character, press c (Start)
To open User Dictionary window to check
saved content, etc.
Press o (UserDic)
CUse a to set the range, press
c (End)
DSelect Reading field and enter
reading
EPress w (Save)
SMS Templates
Save frequently used words/phrases of up to 70
characters.
APress w and select Templates SMS
templates
BSelect Options Add new
When no SMS templates have been saved
Press w (Add new)
Tip
When the range contains a line break
Character string before line break is saved to
dictionary.
To edit User dictionary
Press o (UserDic) to select start point for Word
registration; perform operations in "User Dictionary
(Japanese)"
( P.4-14). Select Edit entry and registered entries
appear.
4-16
Entering Text
4
CPress c (Select) and enter text
DPress w (Save)
Tip
To use an SMS template ( P.4-10)
To edit an SMS template
aPress w and select Templates ψSMS templates
bHighlight an item to edit and press c (Edit)
cPress c (Select) and edit the text
dPress w (Save)
To delete an SMS template
aPress w and select Templates ψSMS templates
bHighlight an item to delete, select Options ψ
Delete ψSelected ψYes
To delete all SMS templates, in Step b, select Delete
ψAll, enter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) and
select Yes. To delete multiple items, select Delete ψ
Multiple in Step b, check items to delete, press w
(Delete) ψYes.
Phonebook
5-2
Phonebook
5
Saving to Phonebook
Phonebook Entry Items
Save phone numbers, mail addresses, and more for
up to 1,000 entries in Phonebook; USIM Card
Phonebook capacity varies by card. Insert USIM
Card into compatible SoftBank handsets to use
USIM Card Phonebook entries.
Each 820SC Phonebook entry contains items listed
below.
Item Description
Availability
(Quantity)
820SC USIM
Card
Entry
Number a 3-digit number Ye s
(000-999)1
Yes
(000-
0XX)2
Name Single-/double-byte
characters
Yes (Up to
50
characters)
Yes3
Reading Single-byte
characters Yes Yes 3
Phone
Icon
Select one of six
icons
Yes
(Six Icons)
No
Phone
Number
Saved with area
code
Yes
(5 of up to
40 digits
each)
Yes23
Email Single-byte
alphanumerics
Yes
(4 of up to
256
characters
each)
Yes3
(1 address)
Email
Icon
Select one of three
icons Yes No
Categor
y
Select one of twenty
categories Yes Yes 2
Caller
ID
Select incoming call
image from Data
Folder
Yes No
Item Description
Availability
(Quantity)
820SC USIM
Card
5-3
Phonebook
5
1 Use speed dialing ( P.5-13) to initiate voice calls to
primary number saved in Phonebook Entry Numbers 000
- 099.
2 The number of items that can be saved varies by the type
of USIM Card.
3 The number of characters that can be saved varies by the
type of USIM Card.
Call
Notice
Select incoming call
ringtone from Data
Folder
Yes No
Message
Notice
Select incoming S!
Mail/SMS ringtone
from Data Folder
Yes No
Blood
Type
Select one of four
blood types Ye s N o
Birthday Enter the party's
date of birth Yes No
Address
Enter up to 20
single-byte
characters for postal
code and up to 50
for address
Yes No
Hobby Up to 100
characters Yes No
URL Up to 100 single-
byte alphanumerics
Yes
(2 URLs) No
Item Description
Availability
(Quantity)
820SC USIM
Card
URL
Icon
Select one of three
icons Yes No
Notes Up to 100
characters Yes No
Secret
Mode Select secret setting Yes No
Note
Item Description
Availability
(Quantity)
820SC USIM
Card
5-4
Phonebook
5
Adding Entry Items
820SC assigns lowest available Entry Number; edit
as required.
ASelect Options Add to Phone or
USIM
BEnter additional items as required
*Not available in USIM Card Phonebook.
To change Entry number
Highlight Entry number field and enter a
number
To save Name
aSelect Name field
Protect important information
Phonebook entries may be lost/altered if battery is
removed or left uncharged for an extended period;
accidents/malfunctions may also affect entries.
Back-up entries and store separately. SoftBank is
not liable for damages from lost information.
Phonebook Details
5-5
Phonebook
5
bEnter a name
To modify Reading Name
aSelect Reading Name field
bEnter a reading name (use katakana to
organize entries in Phonebook list)
To save Phone number
Highlight Phone number field and enter a
number
To set Phone icon
aSelect Phone number field
bSelect an icon
To save Mail address
aSelect Mail address field
bEnter an address
cSelect an icon
To set Category
aSelect Category field
bSelect a Category
To set Caller ID for a Voice Call or Video
Call*
aSelect Caller ID field
bSelect On
cOpen Data Folder to select an image file, etc.
To set Call notice for a Voice or Video Call*
aSelect Call notice field
bSelect On
cOpen Data Folder to select a file
To set S! Mail/SMS Notice*
aSelect Message notice field
bSelect On
cSelect sound
To save Blood type*
aSelect Blood type field
bSelect blood Type
To save Birthday*
Highlight Birthday field and enter a date
To save Address*
5-6
Phonebook
5
aSelect Address field
bEnter a postal code
cSelect Address field and enter an address
dPress w (OK)
To save Hobby*
aSelect Hobby field
bEnter text
To save URL*
aSelect URL field
bEnter a URL
cSelect an icon
To save Memo*
aSelect Notes field
bEnter text
To set Secret Mode*
aSelect Secret Mode field
bSelect On
CPress w (Save)
5-7
Phonebook
5
Saving from Call Log Records
Save numbers from Call Log records to new or
existing Phonebook entries.
APress r
BUse s to open a Call Log, highlight a
record, select Options Add to
Phonebook Phone or USIM
CSelect Phonebook entry type
To create a new entry
Select New
To save to an existing entry
aSelect Update
bOpen the Phonebook entry ( P.5-10)
DSelect a phone icon
EEnter additional items as required
Tip
Valid Phone Field Characters
Enter 0-9, #, *, P (Pause), and + (International Code).
Press * for 1+ seconds to enter P or press 0 for 1+
seconds to enter +.
Saving an Entered Phone Number
During a call, Options ψAdd to Phonebook
aIn Standby, enter a phone number
bOptions ψAdd to Phonebook ψPhone or USIM
cSelect New or Update and select memory
dSelect a phone icon
ePerform Steps 2 and 3
Synchronizing Phonebook with Samsung PC Studio
Secret Mode entries cannot be synchronized or backed-
up to a PC even if Secret Mode is active.
The entries with Secret Mode changed from Off to On,
cannot be synchronized and deleted immediately after
the Secret Mode settings has been changed and tried
synchronization.
For more information about Samsung PC Studio, see
the User's guide in the attached CD-ROM.
5-8
Phonebook
5
FPress w (Save)
Category Settings
Organize Phonebook entries among twenty
Categories.
New Category (USIM Card)
APress c and select Phonebook
BSelect Options View from USIM
CPress w (Search) and select Category
search
DSelect Options New category
EEnter a name
Edit Category
Customize Category names; add images/ringtones to
appear/sound for incoming calls/messages from
members.
APress c and select Phonebook
To select a USIM Card Category
After Step 1, select Options ψView from USIM
BPress w (Search) and select Category
search
CHighlight category to change, select
Options Category settings
DEdit Category items
To change Category name
Select Category name field and enter a name
5-9
Phonebook
5
To set Category image
Select Category image field then select a file
from Data Folder
To set incoming call ringtone
Select Call notice field then select a file from
Data Folder
To set incoming S! Mail/SMS notice
Select Message notice field then select a
ringtone
To restore Category defaults
Highlight item to restore and press o (Reset)
EPress w (Save)
Add Member
APress c and select Phonebook
To select Category on USIM Card
After Step 1, select Options ψView from USIM
BPress w (Search) and select Category
search
CSelect Category to which to add
member
DSelect Options Add member
ECheck the member to add and press
w (Add)
Tip
Incoming Image & Ringtone Priority
Images and ringtones set for individual Phonebook
entries take priority over those set for a Category.
5-10
Phonebook
5
Using Phonebook
Calling from Phonebook
Phonebook Search
APress d
If the correct search method appears first
Proceed to Step 2, Part b
To change method in active search window
Press c and proceed to Step 2
BPress w (Search)
To search Phonebook list
aSelect Phonebook list
bUse s to navigate Phonebook list
To search by Category
aSelect Category search
bSelect Category
To search by name
aSelect Name search
bEnter any part of Name
To search by Reading
aSelect Reading search
bEnter any part of Reading
To search by Entry Number
aSelect Entry No. search
bEnter Entry Number
To search by Phone Number
aSelect Phone No. search
bEnter any part of a phone number
To search by Mail Address
Tip
To delete a member from a Category
Deleting a member from a Category does not affect
member's Phonebook entry.
aPerform Steps 1 and 2 in "Add Member"
bSelect Category from which to delete member
cHighlight member to delete, select Options ψ
Remove ψYes
5-11
Phonebook
5
aSelect Email search
bEnter any part of an mail address
CSelect an entry
To open Entry details
Press c (Details/Select)
Initiating a Call
ASelect an entry, press c (Details) to
view Details window
BSelect a number and initiate a call
To initiate a Voice Call
Press c or select Options ψVoice call
To initiate a Video Call
Select Options ψVideo call
Tip
To set Phonebook preference (Phonebook or USIM
Card Phonebook)
aPress c and select Settings ψPhonebook settings
ψView phonebook from
bSelect Phone memory or USIM memory and press c
(Save)
When Secret Mode is set to Hide
Secret Phonebook entries do not appear. Activate
Secret Mode to search Secret entries.
Entry Details
5-12
Phonebook
5
Calling from Simple Search or search result
Reading name corresponding to the Entry Number
appears. Highlight a phone number, press t or c (Select)
ψc (Call) to initiate a Voice Call; Options ψVideo
call for Video Call.
Calling from Phone No. search or search result
Enter 4-digit number to search and open entry name/
phone number; this search for entries contains the
entered number at the first/last part of the entry. When
Simple search is On and an entry searched, press s to
switch search result between Phone No. search and
Simple search. Highlight a phone number, press t or c
(Select ) ψc (Call) to initiate a Voice Call; select
Options ψVideo call to call a Video Call.
Calling USIM Card Phonebook
Entries
Use Entry Numbers as shortcuts to call numbers
saved in the first 100 USIM Card Phonebook entries.
AEnter last two Entry Number digits
BPress #
If the correct entry is not highlighted
Use j to highlight it
CPress w (Call)
To initiate a Video Call
Press o (V-Call)
Tip
To place a call from Phonebook list
Highlight an entry, select Options ψVoice call or
Video call. When entry contains multiple numbers,
Default Number is dialled if set; otherwise, first
number listed is dialled. If Default Number is Not
assigned, Call window appears; select a number.
5-13
Phonebook
5
Change Search Method
Specify search window to appear first when d is
pressed in Standby.
APress c and select Settings
Phonebook settings Search type
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Speed Dialing
Enter the last two Entry Number digits to call Voice
Call Default Number in Phonebook entries 000 - 099.
AEnter last two Entry Number digits
BPress c ()
Default
Setting
عPhonebook list
Tip
Search Method Items
Phonebook list: Press d in Standby, list appears.
Other settings: Search window appears.
Tip
When Simple search is On ( P.15-7)
Enter Entry No. for names and phone numbers. After 5
seconds, search result disappears. When appears,
press c to dial.
5-14
Phonebook
5
Phonebook Options
Use the following options in Phonebook List or
Entry details.
Note
Speed Dialing is invalid for an entry if Voice Call
Default Number ( P.5-16) is set to Not assigned.
While Secret Mode is set to Hide, Secret Phonebook
entries cannot be dialled.
Item Description
Add to1Start the process of saving a new
entry.
Voice call
Initiate a Voice Call to the
highlighted number or Default
Number ( P.5-11).
Video call
Initiate a Video Call to the
highlighted number or Default
Number ( P.5-11).
Create message
Open a new message addressed to
the number saved as an entry
( P.17-6).
Send
Send entry as a vFile; select Via
message, to open a new message
with entry attached ( P.17-6), or
Via bluetooth, to send entry to
another device wirelessly ( P.12-
6).
Delete Delete an entry ( P.5-17).
Save to Data
Folder
Create a vFile and save it to Other
documents in Data Folder.
Copy to USIM/
Copy to phone ( P.5-16)
View from
USIM/View
from phone1
Toggle Phonebook and USIM
Phonebook.
International
dial
Add international code and country
code to the number ( P.2-2).
Hide/Show my
ID
Show or hide your number when
making calls; Select None to apply
Caller ID setting.
Item Description
5-15
Phonebook
5
1 This item does not appear in Entry details.
2 This item does not appear in Phonebook list.
Editing Phonebook
Entries
To search, list or Entry details, see "Phonebook
Search" ( P.5-10).
Activate Secret Mode to edit Secret Phonebook
entries.
Edit
AOpen Entry details
BPress w (Edit)
CEdit entry items and press w (Save)
Print via
bluetooth
Print highlighted Entry details
(name, phone number information)
using the printer via Bluetooth®
connection.
Memory status1Check memory usage.
Copy item2Copy highlighted entry item.
Mark default
number2( P.5-16)
Item Description
5-16
Phonebook
5
Default Number
When an entry contains multiple phone numbers/
mail addresses, set calling/messaging priorities by
assigning to Default Number.
Resetting an item changes it to Not assigned.
AOpen Entry details
BSelect Options Mark default
number
CSet or reset options
To set
aSelect Voice call,Video call, or Message
bSelect a phone number or mail address
To reset
Highlight Voice call,Video call, or Message
and press o (Reset)
DPress w (Save)
Copy to USIM & Copy to
Phone
AHighlight entry or open Entry details
BCopy the entry
From Phonebook to USIM Card Phonebook
Options ψCopy to USIM ψSelected or All ψ
Yes
From USIM Card Phonebook to Phonebook
Options ψCopy to phone ψSelected or All
Default
Setting
عVoice call: First phone number
عVideo call: First phone number
عMessage: Not assigned
5-17
Phonebook
5
Deleting Entries
Deleting a Single Entry
AHighlight entry or open Entry details
BSelect Options Delete Selected
Yes
Deleting Multiple Entries at Once
AHighlight entries
Toggle Phonebook or USIM Card Phonebook
Options ψView from Phone or View from
USIM
BSelect Options Delete Multiple
CCheck an entry to delete
DRepeat Step 3 to check all target
entries
EPress w (Delete) and proceed to Step
7 when all are not checked
FEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm)
GSelect Yes
Deleting All Entries at Once
Delete all Phonebook or USIM Card Phonebook
entries.
AHighlight entries
Toggle Phonebook and USIM Card
Phonebook
Options ψView from USIM or View from
phone
BSelect Options Delete All
CEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) Yes
5-18
Phonebook
5
My Phonebook Details
Confirm handset phone number. Add your name,
mail address, street address, and other information.
APress c and Press 0
To enter or edit other items
aPress w (Edit)
bEnter/edit items then press w (Save)
Options
Item Description
Send my
phonebook
details
Send as a vFile; select Via message
to create a message with vFile
attached ( P.17-6), or Via
bluetooth to send vFile wirelessly
( P.12-6).
Delete Delete entered owner information.
Save to Data
Folder
Create a vFile and save it to Other
documents in Data Folder.
Copy item Copy highlighted entry item.
Print via
bluetooth
Print My phonebook details (name,
phone number information) using
printer via Bluetooth® connection.
5-19
5-20
Phonebook
5
Video Call
6-2
Video Call
6
Before Using Video Call
Exchange voice/video with compatible 3G handsets.
You may choose not to send your own image ( P.6-
6).
Video Call Precautions
Calls to incompatible handsets may be disconnected;
charges apply.
It may be difficult to use Speaker Phone ( P.6-5)
with earpiece volume raised; lower volume or use
Stereo Earphone Microphone.
Ambient noise may hamper voice quality; use Stereo
Earphone Microphone.
Using Speaker Phone in public may disturb others;
please mind your mobile manners.
Initiating a Video Call
Call via Phonebook entries/Call Log records or dial
directly.
AEnter a phone number
BSelect Options Video call
CPress y to end the call
When Video Call cannot be connected
Unavailable for a video call... appears; select Options
ψVoice call or Create message to contact the recipient,
or View contact details to open Phonebook. Select Add
to Phonebook to save the receiver's number to
Phonebook or USIM Card Phonebook.
Receiving a Video Call
AWhen 820SC rings/vibrates, press
c (Accept)
Loudspeaker on? appears;
Select Yes or No
Allow own picture to be shown? appears;
Select Yes or No
Tip
Engaged Video Call Operations ( P.6-3)
6-3
Video Call
6
BPress y to end the call Engaged Video Call
Operations
Perform operations from Video Call Menu or
Options.
aLarge Display (Normally, the other party's image)
bSmall Display (Normally, your image)
cThe other party's name or phone number
dCall duration
eMeaning of the icon at cursor position
fVideo Call Menu Icons
/ : Toggle Speaker Phone Off/On
: Toggle Incoming Image Size
Tip
To adjust ringtone volume
While 820SC is ringing, press n or b.
When a Stereo Earphone Microphone is connected
Press Stereo Earphone Microphone switch for 1+
seconds to answer Video Calls. Press for 1+ seconds to
end a Video Call.
To disconnect a Video Call without answering it
Press o (Busy)
To change or cancel outgoing image
Set 820SC to send Substitute Image beforehand
( P.6-6). Alternatively, change to Substitute Image
during a call ( P.6-6).
Send Your Image or Substitute Image
After Step 1, Your Image appears. When confirmation
appears, select Yes or No to send Your Image or
Substitute Image. When Video Call connects Your
Image or Substitute Image appears.
Engaged Video Call Operations ( P.6-5)
相田名都
¥ 144 00:00:00
終了
オフ゜ション
c
b
f
a
d
e
6-4
Video Call
6
/ : Freeze or unfreeze outgoing image
(Blue)/ (Gray): Toggle Your Image and
Substitute Image
/ : Freeze or unfreeze incoming image
: Flip image
ADuring Video Calls, select Video Call
Menu or Options to adjust settings
To toggle Speaker Phone off/on
Highlight / and press c
To select incoming image size
Highlight and press c to select an item
To freeze or unfreeze outgoing image
Highlight / and press c
To toggle Your Image and Substitute Image
Highlight (Blue/Gray) and press c
To freeze or unfreeze incoming image
Highlight / and press c
To flip outgoing image
Highlight and press c
To cancel Your Image/mic/key tones
aOptions ψMute
bCheck item(s) to cancel and press w (Save)
When Camera (Your Image) is canceled,
Substitute Image is sent.
To adjust outgoing image appearance/quality
aOptions ψDisplay options ψEffects or
Quality
bHighlight an item and press c
To adjust outgoing image brightness
aOptions ψDisplay options ψBrightness
bUse s to adjust brightness
6-5
Video Call
6
Engaged Video Call Options
Tip
To adjust earpiece volume
Press j during a Video Call.
To enlarge or reduce outgoing image
Press n or b during a Video Call.
When outgoing image is canceled
820SC send caller Substitute Image.
Item Description
Normal/Speaker on Toggle Speaker Phone off/on
( P.6-4).
Mute Cancel sending outgoing image/
mic/key tones ( P.6-4).
Display options Adjust outgoing image
appearance/quality ( P.6-4).
Settings Select Video Call settings ( P.6-
6).
Phonebook Open Phonebook Search
window.
Add to Phonebook
Save number to Phonebook or
USIM Card Phonebook ( P.5-
7).
Send DTMF Send push tones.
Memo Create and save text memos
( P.14-10).
Details Open Phonebook Entry details.
6-6
Video Call
6
Video Call Settings
Sending Your Image
When Always ask is set, Choose between Your Image
or Substitute Image as outgoing image each time a
Video Call is received.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Video call Show my
picture
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Selecting a Substitute Image
Select an image to use as the outgoing image.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Video call Select still
picture
BPress c (Change)
COpen Data Folder, select a file and
press c (Save)
Switch to headset/
Switch to phone
Appears when Bluetooth®-
compatible headset is in use.
Select headset or phone
(handset).
Default
Setting
عAlways ask
Item Description
Default
Setting
عCamera Off
Tip
To restore Substitute Image to its default
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bSelect any image file in Data Folder ψOptions ψ
Reset
6-7
Video Call
6
Retry Settings
APress c and select Settings Call
settingsVideo call Retry with
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Voice M ute
Set Voice mute to On to answer Video Calls with no
sound sending to caller.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Video call Voice mute
BSelect On and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عAlways ask
Tip
Retry with Items
Always ask: Select an action from Options.
Voice call: Redial number as a Voice Call.
Messages: Create a message.
None: Return to Standby after a failed Video Call.
Automatic retry option changes by setting.
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
To send sound
aDuring a Video Call, select Options ψMute
bUncheck Voice
cPress w (Save)
6-8
Mobile Camera
7-2
Mobile Camera
7
Before Using Mobile
Camera
Capture still images in JPEG or video in 3GP format.
Mobile Camera Precautions
Use a dry soft cloth to remove debris from lens
cover.
Avoid camera shake; hold 820SC steady or place it
on a stable surface and use Timer.
Mobile Camera employs high precision
technology, however, some pixels may seem
brighter or darker than others.
Leaving 820SC in a hot place for an extended
period before image capture/save may affect image
quality.
Exposing lens to direct sunlight may affect color
filter.
Rotating Camera
820SC features Rotating Camera. To capture images
or record video, rotate lens inward or outward; press
n (Side Keys) to flip image vertically/horizontally to
suit lens orientation, etc.
Lens inwards
Lens outwards
7-3
Mobile Camera
7
Using Display as Viewfinder
aSize
Still Image: , , ,
, ,
Video : , ,
bQuality
: Superfine : Fine
: Normal : Low
: Economy
cWhite Balance
: Auto : Fine : Cloudy
: Incandescent : Fluorescent
dMode
No display : Single shot
: Multi-shot (6 shots) : Multi-shot (9 shots)
: Multi-shot (15 shots)
: Mosaic shot (2 x 2) : Mosaic shot (3 x 3)
eTimer (When set)
: 3 seconds
: 5 seconds
: 10 seconds
fImage Orientation (Vertical)
: Upright Image (Lens Outward)
: Upright Image (Lens Inward)
gImage Orientation (Horizontal)
: Normal image
: Mirror image
hAudio Recording
: On : Off
iRecording Time
: Limit for S! Mail : 10 seconds
: 30 seconds : Normal recording
Camera Viewfinder Video Viewfinder
e
d
f
g
abc
abchi
jk
00:00:03              22K
l
7-4
Mobile Camera
7
jElapsed Recording Time
kTotal Data Size/Recording Time
lProgress Bar
Capturing a Still Image
Camera Mode
Select Single shot to capture single images, Multishot
or Mosaic shot to capture multiple images. Save
images in Pictures.
Mode Description Image size
Single shot
Capture single images, select
size for purpose; attach
images to S! Mail, save as
Wallpaper, etc.
1600 x 1200
1280 x 960
640 x 480
320 x 240
240 x 320
240 x 192
Multi-shot Press shutter once to capture
6, 9 or 15 sequential images. 320 x 240
Mosaic shot
Capture multiple images, one
at a time; 820SC
automatically combines
single images (4 for
2x 2 or 9 for 3x 3) into one
composite image.
240 x 192
Tip
When using Single shot mode with a frame
Image size is automatically adjusted to 240 x 192.
Mode Description Image size
7-5
Mobile Camera
7
Capturing Still Images
Single Shot
APress e
In Video mode
Press w (Photos) to change to Camera mode
BSelect Options Shooting mode
Single shot Take & save
To save captured images without review
Select Automatic save
CSelect Options and perform other
actions as required ( P.7-6)
DPreview image on Display
Zoom image in/out (invalid for 1600 x 1200)
Use u or d to zoom out or in
Adjust brightness
Use r or l to lighten or darken image
EPress c (Take)
To cancel the image and capture another
Press w (Back)
Tip
To activate/adjust Timer in image preview
Press 5 to toggle
3 seconds
,
5 seconds
,
10 seconds
, and
Off
.
To adjust viewfinder in image preview
Press # to toggle Full screen,Actual ratio,Full screen
without indicator, and Full screen with grid.
To send an image via S! Mail or Bluetooth®
aAfter Step 5, press c (Send) and select send medium
bSend image ( P.12-6, 17-6)
7-6
Mobile Camera
7
Preview Options
Available options may vary by mode and other settings.
Review Options
Item Description
Shooting mode
Select Shooting mode and save
setting for Single shot, or image
count for Multi-shot or Mosaic shot
( P.7-5, 7-9).
Effects
Select Black & White,Sepia or
Negative effects filters. When an
effect is active, select None to
cancel.
Frames Add a frame to image in Single shot
mode.
Timer Activate self-timer ( P.7-5).
Go to photos Open Pictures folder.
Camera settings Select image size, image quality,
etc. ( P.7-13).
Camera
shortcuts
Open a function shortcuts graphic
( P.7-10).
Item Description
Delete Delete the last image captured.
Set as
Set image for Wallpaper,
Phonebook entries, or Substitute
Image.
Edit photo Edit an image in Pictures folder
( P.7-15).
Dynamic Effect Create Flash® images using Still
images ( P.7-19).
Rename Change file name.
mPostcard Create a mobile postcard ( P.7-7).
Go to photos Open Pictures folder.
Lock/Unlock Set/release file protection.
Details Confirm file size or format.
7-7
Mobile Camera
7
Mobile Postcard
Use Single shot,Multi-shot, or Mosaic shot images.
This function renders one of two images as line art,
merging it with the other to create a stamped
photograph.
ACapture an image ( P.7-5, 7-8)
BSelect Options mPostcard
CPress c (Add)
DAdd a second image
To select a still image from Data Folder
aSelect Open
bOpen Data Folder and select an image file
To capture an image
aSelect Take photo
bPress c (Take)
cPress c (Add)
EPress c (Merge) and check result
To change image
aPress C
bHighlight image to change, select Options ψ
Change image
cRepeat Steps 4 and 5
To swap image positions
aPress C
bOptions ψSwap image
cPerform Step 5
FTo edit line art, press o (Edit)
To change line art position
aOptions ψMove
bUse a to move image and press w (Done)
To change line art size
aOptions ψSize
bUse j to adjust image and press w (Done)
7-8
Mobile Camera
7
To rotate line art
aOptions ψRotate
bUse s to rotate image and press w (Done)
To change line art color
aOptions ψChange colour
bUse s to select color and press w (Done)
To adjust line art shadow
aOptions ψShadow on or Shadow off
bPress w (Done)
GPress w (Save) and enter a file name
To save and send image
aPress c (S & S)
bSelect medium and send ( P.12-6, 17-6)
Multi Shot
APress e
In Video mode
Press w (Photos) to change Camera mode
BSelect Options Shooting mode
Multi-shot and select the number of
images to capture
CSelect Options and perform other
actions as required ( P.7-6)
DPreview image on Display
Zoom in/out
Use u or d to enlarge or reduce image
Adjust brightness
Use r or l to lighten or darken image
EPress c (Take)
7-9
Mobile Camera
7
FView captured still image(s)
To view still images individually
aHighlight the image and press c (View)
bPress C
To retake a still image
Press w (Back)
Mosaic Shot
APress e
In Video mode
Press w (Photos) to change Camera mode
BSelect Options Shooting mode
Mosaic shot to select the number of
images to capture
CSelect Options and perform other
actions as required ( P.7-6)
DPreview image on Display
Zoom in/out
Use u or d to zoom in or out
Adjust brightness
Use r or l to brighten or darken image
EPress c (Take) for each image
FView captured still images
To retake an image
Press w (Back)
Mosaic Mode (2 x 2)
7-10
Mobile Camera
7
Shortcut Key Operations
Press the assigned key to change item settings.
Available shortcuts vary by mode or setting status.
Capturing Video
Video Mode
Capture clips to attach to mail or save as mementos.
Alternatively, capture clips without sound. Files are
saved in 3GP format to Videos folder in Data Folder.
Key Item Description
1Size
1600 x 1200, 1280 x 960,
640 x 480, 320 x 240,
240 x 320, 240 x 192
2 Quality Superfine, Fine, Normal,
Low, Economy
3Shooting
mode
Single shot, Multi-shot (6, 9,
15 shots), Mosaic shot (2 x 2,
3 x 3)
4 White balance Auto, Fine, Cloudy,
Incandescent, Fluorescent
5 Timer 3 seconds, 5 seconds, 10
seconds
6Frames Select from 9 types
7Effects Black & White, Sepia,
Negative
0Photo album -
# Screen mode
Toggle Full screen, Actual
ratio, Full screen without
indicator, Full screen with
grid
wMode switch -
nVertic al
inverse -
bHorizontal
inverse -
jZoom -
sBrightness -
Key Item Description
7-11
Mobile Camera
7
Recording Video
APress e
In Camera mode
Press w (Videos) to open Video mode
BSelect Options and perform other
actions as required ( P.7-11)
CPreview image on Display
Zoom in/out
Use u or d to enlarge or reduce image
Adjust brightness
Use r or l to lighten or darken image
DPress c (Record)
EPress c (Save) and end
After recording time elapses
Recording ends and clip is saved automatically.
FPress c (Play) to view clip
To continue recording
Press w (Back)
Preview Options
Tip
To activate/adjust Timer
In image preview, press 5 to toggle
3 seconds
,
5
seconds
,
10 seconds
,
Off
.
Item Description
Effects
Select Black & White,Sepia, or
Negative effects filters. When an
effect is active, select None to
cancel.
Timer Activate self-timer ( P.7-11).
Go to videos Open Videos folder.
Video settings Select image size, image quality,
etc. ( P.7-14).
Camcorder
shortcuts
Open a function shortcuts graphic
( P.7-12).
7-12
Mobile Camera
7
Review Options
Shortcut Key Operations
Change settings by pressing key assigned to each item.
Item Description
Edit Edit Video files in Data Folder (P.7-
17).
Resolution Select video display size while
playing or paused.
Send Send file via S! Mail ( P.17-6) or
Bluetooth® ( P.12-6).
Set as Set captured videos as Voice
ringtone or Video ringtone.
Delete Delete the last video captured.
Rename Change file name.
Go to videos Open Videos folder.
Lock/Unlock Set/release file protection.
Details Confirm file size or format.
Key Item Description
1Size 320 x 240, 176 x 144,
128 x 96
2Quality Fine, Normal, Low,
Economy
3Shooting time
Limit for S! Mail, 10
seconds, 30 seconds,
Normal recording
4White balance Auto, Fine, Cloudy,
Incandescent, Fluorescent
5Timer 3 seconds, 5 seconds, 10
seconds
6Audio
recording On, Off
7Effects Black & White, Sepia,
Negative
0Record album -
wMode switch -
nVertical
inverse -
bHorizontal
inverse -
jZoom -
sBrightness -
Key Item Description
7-13
Mobile Camera
7
Mobile Camera Settings
Adjust image size, quality, save location, etc.
Camera Settings
APress e
In Video mode
Press w (Photos) to change to Camera mode
BSelect Options Camera settings
CSelect an item and set
To set image size
aSelect Size
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set image quality
aSelect Quality
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set Viewfinder
aSelect Viewfinder
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set the shutter sound
aSelect Shutter sound
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set sequential shot speed
aSelect Multi-shot speed
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set the Single shot mode
aSelect Single shot mode
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عSize: 240 x 320 عQuality: Normal
عViewfinder: Full screen
عShutter sound: Shutter 1
عMulti-shot speed: High
عSingle shot mode: Take & save
عWhite balance: Auto
عDefault name: Photo
7-14
Mobile Camera
7
To set white balance
aSelect White balance
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set file name
aSelect Default name
bEnter file name
Video Settings
APress e
In Camera mode
Press w (Videos) to change to Video mode
BSelect Options Video settings
CSelect an item and adjust settings
To set duration
aSelect Recording time
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set size
aSelect Size
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set image quality
aSelect Quality
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set voice recording
aSelect Audio recording
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To set file name
aSelect Default name
bEnter file name
Default
Setting
ع Recording time: Limit for S! Mail
ع Size: 176 x 144
ع Quality: Economy ع Audio recording:
On
ع Default name: Video
7-15
Mobile Camera
7
Viewing Images
View images/video clips saved in Data Folder.
Viewing Still Images
APress e
In Video mode
Press w (Photos) to change Camera mode
BSelect Options Go to photos
CHighlight a file and press c (View)
Viewing Videos
APress e
In Camera mode
Press w (Videos) to change to Video mode
BSelect Options Go to videos
CHighlight and select a file and press c
(Play)
Editing Still Images
Edit image files saved in Data Folder.
APress c, select Data folder and select
an image to edit
BHighlight a file and press c (View)
CPress c (Edit)
Tip
Video recording time
For
Normal recording
, record up to one hour of video.
When Recording time is set to Limit for S! Mail
Size 320
x
240
is not selectable and Quality is
Economy
.
7-16
Mobile Camera
7
DEdit using Options
To change the size of an image
aSelect Resize
bSelect the setting
cEnter Width or Height (If Customise is
selected)
dPress w (Done)
To add effects to an image
aSelect Effects
bSelect the setting
cPress w (Done)
To add blur or correct red-eye
aSelect Partial effects ψPartial blur or
Redeye repair
bOptions and select the suitable operation
cPress w (Done)
To adjust an image
aSelect Adjust ψBrightness/Contrast/Colour
bAdjust the image
cPress w (Done)
To add a frame
aSelect Frames
bUse s to select a frame
cPress w (Done)
To add clip art to an image
aSelect Cliparts
bSelect a piece of clip art to add to an image
cOptions ψSize and use j to adjust clip art
size
dOptions ψRotate and use s to turn clip art
eOptions ψMove and use a to move clip art
fPress w (Done)
To add text to image (320 x 240 or above)
aSelect Insert text
bEnter text
cOptions ψSize and use j to adjust text size
dOptions ψRotate and use s to turn text
eOptions ψFont size ψLarge/Normal/Small
7-17
Mobile Camera
7
fOptions ψColour and use a to adjust text
color
gPress w (Done)
To rotate image
aSelect Rotate
bSelect 90° R or 90° L
cPress w (Done)
To flip ima ge
aSelect Flip
bSelect Vertically or Horizontally
cPress w (Done)
To crop image
aSelect Crop
bOptions ψSize and use j to adjust trimming
size
cOptions ψShape and use s to select
trimming shape
dOptions ψMove and use a to adjust
trimming position
eOptions ψCrop
fPress w (Done)
EPress c (Save)
FEnter a name for the image
Editing Video
Edit Video files in Data Folder.
APress c, and select Data Folder
Videos
BHighlight a file, select Options Edit
CEdit using Options
To cut video
aSelect Cut
bPress c (Play)
cPress w (Start) at the start point
dPress w (End) at the End point
eTo cancel and retry, press o (Reset) and
repeat b to d
7-18
Mobile Camera
7
fPress w (Done)
To merge multiple videos
aSelect Merge
bCheck files to merge (Up to ten files)
cRepeat b to check all target files
dPress w (Done)
ePress c (Merge)
To replace sound from other video/sound
aSelect Replace sound ψFrom other video or
From other sound
bPress c (Open)
cSelect a file and press w (Done)
DPress c (Save)
EEnter a file name
Tip
To confirm video before editing
Press w (Preview)
To add files to merge videos
aAfter e in Step 3 in "To merge multiple videos,"
select Options ψAdd
bPerform b to e in Step 3 in "To merge multiple
videos"
To delete the file order for merging
aAfter e in Step 3 in "To merge multiple videos,"
use s to highlight the file to delete
bOptions ψDelete ψYes
To change the file order for merging
aAfter e in Step 3 in "To merge multiple videos,"
use s to highlight the file to move
bOptions ψChange order
cUse s to highlight a personal folder or a file,
highlight the file and press c
7-19
Mobile Camera
7
Create Flash®
Create Flash® images using still images saved in
Pictures folder, already created Flash® images saved
in Other documents folder, or still images previewed
immediately after shooting; newly created Flash®
images are saved to Other documents folder in Data
Folder.
APress c and Camera Dynamic effect
list
BSelect files
CPerform creation operations
To add frame to image
aSelect (Frame)
bSelect frame
To add icon to image
aSelect (Icon)
bSelect icon
cOptions ψSize, use j to adjust size and press
w (Done)
dOptions ψRotate and use s to adjust angle
eUse a to adjust position and w (Done)
fRepeat a to e to add more icons
To add text to image
aSelect (Text)
bEnter text
cOptions ψFont size and adjust size and
press w (Done)
dOptions ψFont color and use s to adjust
color and press w (Done)
eUse a to adjust the position and w (Done)
fUse s to change scroll direction and press
w (Done)
gTo add more text, select (Text), press
c (Insert) and repeat b to g
7-20
Mobile Camera
7
To add watch on image
aSelect (Watch)
bSelect the watch
cPress w (Done)
To reset image during editing
aSelect (Reset)
bSelect Yes
DPress w (Save)
EEnter an image name
Attaching Images
Attach captured image or recorded video to S! Mail.
AAfter capturing, press c (Send) As
message
To send video
In image review, select Options ψSend ψAs
message
BEnter an address, subject, text, etc.,
and send
Tip
To delete added frame/watch
aAfter Step 2, select (Frame) or (Watch)
bPress w (Delete)
To delete added icon(s)/text
aAfter Step 2, select (Icon) or (Text)
bUse s to highlight more icons/text to delete
cPress w (Delete)
dPress c (Done)
Available icon/text to add
Up to 5 icons/texts can be added.
To create Flash® images using Data Folder images
aHighlight image saved in Data Folder and select
Options ψDynamic Effect
bPerform Steps 1 to 3 ( P.7-19) in "Create Flash®"
Note
Created Flash® images cannot be sent as message.
7-21
Mobile Camera
7
Tip
To send a still image or video via Bluetooth®
Select Via bluetooth in Step 1 ( P.12-6).
7-22
Display Settings
8-2
Display Settings
8
Standby Display Settings
Wallpaper
Set an image, animation, Slide Show or mPet world
image to appear in Standby.
A
Press
c
and select
Settings
Display
settings
Wallpaper
BPerform operations to set
To change settings
Select Pictures,Slide show,mPet world image,
or None
To change the image
aHighlight Pictures and press w (Edit)
bSelect a folder then a file
cPress c (Set)
To set/edit the image of Slide Show
aSelect Slide show and press w (Edit)
bPerform Steps 2 to 4 in "Slide Show" ( P.8-
2) or perform Steps 2 and 3 in "Editing Slide
Show" ( P.8-3)
CPress c (Save)
Slide Show
APress c and select Tools Slide show
BPress c (Add)
Default
Setting
عPictures
Tip
After setting mPet
mPet operations are enabled ( P.24-5). Press y to
show Standby as usual; various operations can be
performed.
Note
If no pet is selected in mPet,mPet world image
cannot be set as Wallpaper.
8-3
Display Settings
8
CSelect a folder, check an image and
press w (Done)
To see preview
aPress w (Preview) and select Yes (cropped
image) or No (original image)
bPress C to close the preview
To set effect
aUse j to highlight Effect field
bUse s to toggle setting
To change the slide interval
aUse j to highlight Duration field
bUse s to highlight Effect field
DPress c (Set) and select Yes (crop
sides) or No (show full image)
Editing Slide Show
APress c and select Tools Slide show
BEdit Slide image
To edit still images
aOptions ψReplace
bCheck a still image to set and press w (Done)
To change image order
aHighlight images to change and select
Options ψChange Order
bUse a to change order and press c (Save)
To delete a still image
Highlight image to delete, select Options ψ
Delete ψYes
To add a still image
Tip
To adjust slide size
For a larger image, select Yes in Step 4. For the original
image, select No.
8-4
Display Settings
8
aHighlight an empty slide and press o (Add)
bCheck a still image to add and press w
(Done)
CPress c (Set) and select Yes or No
Clock Display
Set Digital clock, Dual clock or Calendar to appear in
Standby. Alternatively, hide clock in Standby.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Clock display
BSelect settings
Digital clock
aSelect Digital clock
bPress w (Edit) and use s to select clock type
cPress c
Dual clock
aSelect Dual clock
bPress w (Edit)
cPerform Step 3 in "Changing Home Time
Zone" ( P.1-23)
To display calendar
Select Calendar
To hide clock
Select Off
CPress c (Save)
Tip
To adjust slide size
Select Yes in Step 3 to enlarge the image.
Default
Setting
عOff
8-5
Display Settings
8
Operator Name
In Standby, show or hide operator name.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Operator name
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Menu Display
Menu Style
Change menu appearance.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Main menu style
BPerform operations to set
To set Bicycle
aSelect Bicycle
bUse s to change the type
cPress d and Use s to change seasons
To set Amoeba or Slider
aSelect Amoeba or Slider
bUse s to change the type
To set Black
Tip
When Dual clock is set
Two clocks appear in Standby. Top time is that of the
zone selected in "Changing Home Time Zone" ( P.1-
23) and bottom time is that of the zone set in Dual
clock ( P.8-4).
Default
Setting
عOff
Default
Setting
عBlack
8-6
Display Settings
8
Proceed to Step 4
CPress c
DPress w (Save)
Popup Menu
When active, sub menus appear in a popup window
when a menu item is highlighted.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Popup menu
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
List Font Size
Set main menu item font size.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings List font size
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
When an item with no sub menu is highlighted
Nothing appears. Popup menus do not appear in
Alarms.
Default
Setting
ع Large
8-7
Display Settings
8
Zoom List
When active, highlighted menu items appear larger.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Zoom list
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Backlight Brightness &
Duration
Adjusting Display Brightness
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Brightness
BUse a to adjust brightness and press c
(Save)
Backlight Duration
Set backlight time. Display becomes dimmer when
time set in On elapses and turns off when time set in
Dim elapses.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Backlight time
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
Effective Range
Zoom list applies only to items in sub-sub menus or
lower. For example, select Settings ψCall settings ψ
Voice call ψDiverts.Voice call items appear zoomed.
Default
Setting
عOn: 15 seconds عDim: 5 seconds
8-8
Display Settings
8
BSelect an item and set it
To set illumination time
aSelect On field
bSelect time and press c
To set panel off time
aSelect Dim field
bSelect time and press c
CPress w (Save)
Sub LCD Light
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Sub LCD light
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Dialing Display
Appears when dialing in Standby. When character
type is set to Normal or Serif, select font size, color
and background color.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Dialling display
Default
Setting
عPower saving mode
Tip
Sub LCD light settings
On: Closing 820SC illuminates Sub LCD; Clock
appears for 3 seconds only; Sub Display indicators
remain on.
Power saving mode: Closing 820SC illuminates Sub
LCD for 3 seconds.
Off: Sub LCD remains off.
Opening 820SC automatically turns Sub LCD off.
Default
Setting
عFont type: Normal
8-9
Display Settings
8
BSelect an item and set it
To set font type
aSelect Font type
bUse s to switch font type
To set the font size
aSelect Font size
bUse s to select the size
To set font color
aSelect Font colour
bUse s to select the setting
cUse u to move cursor to Color selection field
and use s to select a color (For Monochrome
only)
To set background color
aSelect Background colour
bUse s to select the color
CPress c (Save)
Greeting Messages
Change power on message for Display.
APress c and select Settings Display
settings Greeting message Main
LCD or Sub LCD
BEdit power on message text
Default
Setting
عMain LCD: No entry
عSub LCD: No entry
8-10
Display Settings
8
Display Language
Set 820SC user interface to appear in English,
Japanese, or Korean.
APress c and select
Language or
BSelect English and press c (保存/Save/
)
Default
Setting
عᣣᧄ⺆ (Japanese)
設定
一般設定
言語選択
Sound Settings
9-2
Sound Settings
9
Changing Profile Settings
Change 820SC incoming transmission response by
profile.
In Car Profile, select Call answer mode.
AIn Standby, press * for 1+ seconds
BHighlight a profile and press w (Edit)
To set Ringtone volume
aSelect Ringtone volume and select item to set
bUse s to adjust volume
cPress w (Play) to confirm volume and press c
dPress w (Save)
To set Voice/Video Call ringtone
aSelect Ringtone and Voice call or Video call
bSelect the save location for files
cHighlight a melody, select Options ψPlay
dPress o (Select)
ePress w (Save)
To set S! Mail/SMS ringtone
aSelect Ringtone and Messages
bSelect setting
cPress w (Play) to confirm ringtone and press
c
dPress w (Save)
To set vibration
aSelect Vibration and select items
bSelect setting and press c (Save)
To set S! Mail/SMS ring duration
aSelect Message ringtone duration
bEnter duration and press c
To set sound effect or key tone volume
aSelect Key tone volume
bUse s to adjust volume and press c (Save)
9-3
Sound Settings
9
To set Phone sounds
aSelect Phone sounds
bCheck items to set and press w (Save)
To set key tone
aSelect Key tones
bSelect setting and press c (Save)
To set Car Profile answering method
aSelect Call answer mode
bSelect setting and press c (Save)
Tip
Ringtone volume
Select for step-up ringer.
Acoustic shock
Reduces ringer volume to Level 1 for the first two
seconds.
Car Profile Call answer mode
If Any key is set, press any key except w , o , y , or Side
Key n or b.
To set Car Profile auto answer time
After b in "To set Car Profile answering method" in
Step 2, select Automatic and press w (Edit); edit
answer time and press c.
To Voice recorder recording as ringtone
After b in "To set ringtone" in Step 2, select amr file.
To adjust the volume while 820SC rings
Press Side Key n or b while 820SC rings.
To turn ringer and vibration off
Mute Ringtone volume and set Vibration Off; mute
indicator ( ) appears.
9-4
Sound Settings
9
Sound settings
Change Normal Profile sound settings here.
To change ringtone title for S! Mail/SMS
aAfter b in "To set ringtone for S! Mail/SMS" in
Step 2, highlight Data Folder and press o (Change)
bSelect location to save the file
cHighlight the file, select Options ψPlay
dPress o (Select)
ePress w (Save)
To adjust key tone volume
In Standby, press Side Key n or b.
9-5
Sound Settings
9
Profile settings
Available items vary by Profile. Defaults are as listed below.
Profile
Item Normal Manner Car Meeting Outdoor
Ringtone volume
Voice call Level 4 N/A Level 4 Off Level 5
Video call Level 4 N/A Level 4 Off Level 5
Messages Level 4 N/A Level 4 Off Level 5
Ringtone
Voice call 03 acapella.mmf N/A 03 acapella.mmf 03 acapella.mmf 03 acapella.mmf
Video call Techno
Dance.mp4 N/A Techno
Dance.mp4
Techno
Dance.mp4
Techno
Dance.mp4
Messages Pure N/A Pure Pure Pure
Vibration
Voice call On On On On On
Video call On On On On On
Messages On On On On On
9-6
Sound Settings
9
Profile
Item Normal Manner Car Meeting Outdoor
Message ringtone
duration 5 Seconds N/A 5 Seconds 5 Seconds 5 Seconds
Key tone volume Level 2 N/A Level 4 Off Level 5
Phone sounds Several tones On Alerts on call Several tones On Alerts on call Several tones On
Key tones Xylophone N/A Xylophone Xylophone Xylophone
Call answer mode N/A N/A Normal N/A N/A
Answer machine N/A On N/A N/A N/A
9-7
Sound Settings
9
Phone Sounds
Available items vary by Profile. Volume Level set in
Key Tone Volume applies to all Phone Sounds.
Item Description
All Check/uncheck all items.
Popup box
alerts Sounds for confirmations/warnings.
Minute minder Sounds about once a minute during
calls.
Call connect
tone
Sounds when calls connect before
called phone rings.
Call end tone Sounds when a call ends.
Power on Sounds when power turns on.
Open/close
folder
Sounds when 820SC is opened/
closed.
Alerts on call Sounds for alarms/incoming
transmissions.
9-8
Media Player
10-2
Media Player
10
Before Using Media
Player
Play Data Folder sound/video files or stream online
media.
From Music or Video menu, select Download
music or Download videos, to download files via
Yahoo! Keitai.
Use Stereo Earphone Microphone. Insert as shown
below. Unplug Stereo Earphone Microphone to use
Speaker.
Use Stereo Earphone Microphone to accept Voice
Calls. When 820SC rings/vibrates, press switch for
1+ seconds to answer the call.
Playable File Formats
Left
Right
Stereo
Earphone
Connector
Player File (Extension)
Music MPEG4 Audio (mp4, aac, 3gp (Sound
only))
Video MPEG4 (mp4, 3gp)
Tip
Other Playback Conditions
Media Player will only play files described above
saved in Sounds & Ringtones in Data Folder; select
directly from Data Folder.
10-3
Media Player
10
Playing Music
APress c and select Media Player
Music
BSelect files
Select from All music,Recent music or Most
played music and highlight a file. Play files
from Playlist ( P.10-6)
CPress c (Play)
aArtist's name and title (File name when title is
unknown)
bSkin
cStatus : PLAY, PAUSE, STOP
dRepeat mode
(Off), (One), (Shuffle), (All)
eFile number/Total number of files
fPlaying volume
gTotal playing time
hElapsed playing time
iProgress bar
Natsu Aida−Evening Waltz
a
e
g
h
i
b
c
d
f
Melody Player Window
Tip
To end playback and return to Options
Press C. In Options, press C to return to the previous
menu or close Options menu.
Incoming calls
Playback pauses and 820SC rings; after call ends
playback remains paused.
Incoming messages
or appears and 820SC vibrates.
10-4
Media Player
10
All music
Lists all playable files (up to 9999 files).
Download music
Shortcut to download site.
Music search
Shortcut to Music search. site; search by genre or
keyword.
Recent music/Most played music
Most recently played file appears first in Recent music.
Most frequently played file appears first in Most played
music. Each list holds up to 100 records.
Player Window & List Options
Available items vary by file type, etc.
Alarm times
Playback pauses, Alarm sounds and details appear.
Press any key to cancel alarm and resume playback;
press another key to reopen Media Player window.
Saving files as Ringtone
Highlight a file in list or from pause or stop, press w
(Set as) and select a function. Only valid files can be
saved.
Using other functions
Use Switch Bar ( P.1-26).
Item Description
Send Send file via S! Mail ( P.17-6) or
Bluetooth® ( P.12-6).
Add
Add files to Playlist. Select
Playlist to add all files contained
in another Playlist. Select Files to
add selected files to Playlist.
Move track in
playlist Change order of files in Playlist.
View bookmark
Access a page containing a
streaming play link saved as a
bookmark.
View history
Access a page containing a
streaming play link already
accessed.
Add to playlist
Files in All music are added to Play
List. Choose Selected file to add
highlighted file, or Multiple file to
add multiple files to Playlist.
Play by Play tracks by album, artist or
genre.
10-5
Media Player
10
Create Playlist
Playing Files from Playlists
Create up to 20 Playlists, containing up to 100 files
each.
APress c and select Media Player
Music
BSelect Options Create playlist
CEnter Playlist name
DSelect the created Playlist
ESelect Options Add Files
Delete Delete a highlighted file or all
files.
Rename Change file name.
Lock/Unlock Set/release file protection.
Details Confirm file size, etc.
Stop End playback.
Play via
In Player window, select
Headphone or Speaker ( P.12-7)
for sound output.
Transfer to A/V
headset/Transfer
to Phone
Select Headphone or Speaker
( P.12-7) as sound output source.
Download
content key Purchase or acquire Content Key.
Create playlist Create new Playlist ( P.10-5).
Rename Change Playlist name.
Open playlist Open Playlist.
Player settings Adjust Media Player settings
( P.10-6).
Item Description Tip
When Transfer to A/V headset is set
Raise/lower volume from A/V headset.
10-6
Media Player
10
FCheck files to save and press
w (Save)
Play
APress c and select Media Player
Music
BSelect Playlist to play, select Options
Play
Changing Music Player
Settings
Repeat Mode
Play a single track repeatedly, all files in All music,
or tracks from Playlist, randomly or repeatedly.
APress c and select Media Player
Music
Tip
To create a Playlist from tracks in an existing one:
aPerform Steps 1 to 3
bOptions ψAdd ψPlaylist
cSelect Playlist from which to add all melodies
To change Playlist name
aHighlight Playlist, select Options ψRename
bEnter Playlist name
To delete selected Playlist
Options ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
To delete all Playlists
aHighlight Playlist, select Options ψDelete ψAll
bEnter Phone Password and press c (Confirm)
cSelect Yes
Default
Setting
عOFF
10-7
Media Player
10
BSelect Options Player settings
Repeat mode
CSelect an item and press c (Save)
Tone Volume
APress c and select Media Player
Music
BSelect Options Player settings
Tone volume
CUse a to adjust the volume and press
c (Save)
Audio Skin
Set one of two images to appear while music plays.
APress c and select Media Player
Music
BSelect Options Player settings
Audio Skin
CSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Visualization Mode
Visualization On/Off
Activate or cancel this setting to apply or cancel
Skin, Controller and Backlight settings while playing
MPEG4 AAC or AAC+ files.
APress c and select Media Player
Music
Default
Setting
عRainbow wave
Default
Setting
عOn
10-8
Media Player
10
BSelect Options Player settings
Visualization Visualization mode
CSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Skin, Show Controller, & Backlight
Select one of ten skins to appear while music plays.
Set Show controller to Hide for full screen view. Set
Backlight to Always on to see skin with handset
open.
APress c and select Media Player
Music
BSelect Options Player settings
Visualization Skin,Show controller,
or Backlight
CSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Playing Video
APress c and select Media Player
Video
BSelect files
From All Video
Select All Video and highlight the file
From Recent video
Select Recent video and highlight the file
From Most Played video
Select Most Played video and highlight the file
From Playlist ( P.10-6)
Default
Setting
عSkin: Flowers
عShow controller: Show
عBacklight: Normal
10-9
Media Player
10
CPress c (Play)
aArtist's name and title (File name when the video
title information is unknown)
bPlaying status : PLAY/PAUSE/STOP
cProgress bar
dFile no./Total number of files
ePlaying volume level
fTotal playing time
gElapsed playing time
All Video
All (up to 9999) playable files appear.
Download videos
Shortcut to download site.
Recent video/Most Played video
Most recently played file appears first in Recent video.
Most frequently played file appears first in Most Played
Video. Each list holds up to 100 records.
Natsu Movie−1
a
g
b
c
d
e
f
Video Player Window
Tip
To set video file as Ringtone
Highlight paused file or one from list and press w (Set
as). Set file as Ringtone ( P.11-11). Valid only for
compatible files.
• Playlist
aAfter Step 1, select Options ψCreate playlist
bPerform Steps 2 to 5 in "Create Playlist" ( P.10-5)
10-10
Media Player
10
Player Window & List Options
Select Options in Player window or list and perform
operations listed below. Available items vary by file
type, etc.
Item Description
Full screen view Play video in full screen view.
Add
Add files to Playlist. Select Playlist
to add all files contained in another
Playlist. Select individual files to
add to Playlist.
Move track in
playlist Change order of files in Playlist.
Stop End video playback.
Edit Edit video files ( P.7-17).
Resolution Set video display size.
Send Send file via S! Mail ( P.17-6) or
Bluetooth® ( P.12-6).
View bookmark
Access a page containing a
streaming link saved as a
bookmark.
View history Access a page containing a
streaming link already accessed.
Add to playlist
Add a file to Playlist in All Video.
Select Selected file to add
highlighted file to Playlist.
Select Multiple file to add multiple
files.
Delete Delete a highlighted file or all files.
Rename Change file name.
Lock/Unlock Set/release file protection.
Details Confirm file size, etc.
Play via
In Player window, select
Headphone or Speaker ( P.12-7)
for sound output.
Transfer to A/V
headset/
Transfer to
Phone
Select Headphone or Speaker
( P.12-7) as sound output source.
Create playlist Create new Playlist ( P.10-5).
Rename Change Playlist name.
Player settings Adjust Media Player settings
( P.10-11).
Item Description
10-11
Media Player
10
Player Settings
Repeat Mode
Play a file repeatedly or files in a folder randomly/
repeatedly.
APress c and select Media Player
Video
BHighlight a file and press c (Play)
CSelect Options Player settings
Repeat mode
DSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Tone Volume
APress c and select Media player
Video
BHighlight a file and press c (Play)
CSelect Options Player settings
Tone volume
DUse a to adjust the volume and press
c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
10-12
Media Player
10
Resolution
Adjust video size during playback or while paused.
APress c and select Media Player
Video
BHighlight a file and press c (Play)
CSelect Options Resolution and
select a size
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11-2
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Data Folder
820SC files are organized in folders by file format.
Default Folders
Data Folder contains six default folders; new files are
saved to the appropriate folder (see right). Create
additional sub-folders in Default folders as required.
Data Folder
Pictures
Sounds & Ringtones
S! Appli
Book
Other documents
Memory status
Videos
Default
̪Sub-folder Pre-installed
(For files which come
pre-installed with
Folder Description File Formats1
Pictures All still images
JPEG, BMP, GIF,
WBMP, PNG,
Animation GIF
Videos All videos MPEG4 (3GP,
MP4)
Sounds
&
Ringtones
All sounds
recorded with
Voice Recorder,
downloaded music,
and other sound
files
SMAF/MIDI/SP-
MIDI,
MPEG4 Audio,
AMR
S! Appli S! Appli JAVA
Book
Save downloaded
electronic comic/
photo book files
CCF
Other
documents
Documents,
graphics/animation
requiring File
Viewer for display;
Flash® files,
vFiles, etc. are
saved here
SWF, SVG,
vCard,
vCalendar,
PDF, XLS,
DOC, PPT,
TXT,
Unsupported files
11-3
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
1 Copy or move sorted files to other folders as required.
Memory status
Select to view memory usage of each Data Folder.
Alternatively, use setup menu to view memory status
( P15-8).
Download links
appears in Data Folder for download site shortcut.
Select to connect to the download site.
Download Book
In Data Folder, Use Download Book in Book Folder as
a download site shortcut. Select it to open the site.
Tip
Savable number of files/folders
Up to 999 files/folders can be saved each Default
Folder.
11-4
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Saved Files
Opening Files
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect the folder where a file is saved
CHighlight a file and press c (View/
Play/Select/Start)
Tip
To use Slide Show
aPerform Steps 1 to 3 to display images
bOptions ψSlide show
To enlarge or reduce image
aPerform Steps 1 to 3 to display an image
bOptions ψZoom
cPress w ( ), o ( ), or a to enlarge, reduce, or
scroll the image
After selecting zoom, press o ( ) to open list
window. Press o ( ) to change window view; select
another file.
dPress C to return to the previous window
File List Indicators
: Nontransferable
: Nontransferable & unusable
: Protected
: Copy Protected file (Transferable, Content Key
valid)
: Copy Protected file (Transferable, Content Key
expired)
: Copy Protected file (Nontransferable, Content
Key valid)
: Copy Protected file (Nontransferable, Content
Key expired)
: Set as Wallpaper ( P.11-11)
: Set as Ringtone ( P.11-12)
11-5
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Activating Camera or Voice Recorder from
Data Folder
Select Options ψTake photo; activate Camera in
Camera mode by highlighting the Pictures folder or an
image file captured by 820SC.
Select Options ψRecord video; activate Camera in
Video mode by highlighting the Videos folder or a
video captured by 820SC.
Select Options ψRecord sound; activate Voice
Recorder by highlighting the Sounds & Ringtones
folder or sound file captured by 820SC.
When another USIM Card is inserted into 820SC
Only preinstalled nontransferable/copy protected files
are usable.
To show image in Full screen view
After Step 3, select Options ψFull screen view. For
partial image, use a to change display area. Press o
(Rotate) to rotate the image. Press C to return to
previous view.
To view File Details
Options ψDetails
Note
Files over 3 MB cannot be opened. Files larger than
1600 x 1200 pixels cannot be edited or zoomed. Files
over 1.3 MB cannot be set as Incoming image or
Substitute Image.
11-6
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Using File Viewer
Open PDF, XLS, DOC, PPT, or TXT files saved in
Data Folder; File Viewer activates automatically.
Select Normal View or Full Screen View; navigate
files via Options or shortcuts.
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect file location then file
CSelect Options/navigation shortcuts to
navigate
To scro ll
Press a
To change Display appearance
Options ψFull screen view or Normal view
To enlarge or reduce the image
aOptions ψZoom
bPress In or Out to enlarge/reduce
To fit document size to Display
Options ψFit to screen
To move a page
Options ψGo to and select an item
To move to specified page
aOptions ψGo to ψPage
bEnter page number
To capture current screen image
Select Screen capture
Normal View
Full Screen View
Navigatio
n
11-7
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
To rotate image 90 degrees clockwise
aOptions ψRotate
bOptions ψRotate to return to the previous
window
To search words in the page
aOptions ψSearch
bEnter words
cPress 3 to continue searching forward or
press 1 to continue searching backward, for
the same word
To view assigned shortcut keys
Options ψFileViewer shortcuts
File Viewer Settings
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect save location and select the file
CSelect Options Settings
DPerform operations to set
To assign scroll range per press of a
aSelect Panning
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
To fit text width to Display
aSelect Reflow
bSelect On and press c (Save)
Tip
After capturing
Captured files are saved in Other documents in 820SΤ
Data Folder (Phone) as JPEG format.
Default
Setting
عPanning: 10 pixel عReflow: Off
عMap on: On عController: On
عName: Capture
11-8
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
To set Map (shows display position) on/off
aSelect Map on
bSelect a setting and press c (Save)
To set guide for shortcuts in Full screen view
aOptions ψSettings ψController
bSelect a setting and press c (Save)
To change default file mane
aSelect Name
bEnter a name
Navigation Shortcuts
Confirmation Window & List Options
For items other than window operation options, see
"Data Folder Options" ( P.11-14).
Tip
When Reflow is On
Fit text width (such as doc. or txt.) to 820SC window
width. No need to scroll right/left to show the contents.
When Map on is On
In bottom left of the window, map showing the current
position/area in the whole page appears. The current
position/area is indicated in red frame.
Key Description
Side Key nZoom in
Side Key bZoom out
2 Move to the first page
4Move to the previous page
5Rotate 90 degrees clockwise or
cancel
6Move to the next page
8 Move to the final page
*Select Normal View or Full Screen
View
Note
If a document includes many pages or complicated
designs, all pages of the document may not appear
properly.
If a file includes any language other than Japanese
or English, that file may not appear properly.
11-9
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Viewing Graphics/Animation with
the SVG-T/Flash
®
Viewer
View SVG, SVGZ, and SWF formatted files in Data
Folder. When one of these files is selected from Data
Folder list, the SVG-T/Flash® Viewer is
automatically launched.
View the graphics/animation on Normal View or Full
Screen View. In either mode, Options and shortcut
(Key operations) are available to control Display.
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect file location then file
CSelect Options/navigation shortcuts to
navigate
To change Display appearance
Options ψFull screen view or Normal view
To enlarge or reduce the image
aOptions ψZoom
bPress w ( ) to enlarge or o ( ) to reduce
cUse a to scroll the window
dPress c to return to the previous window
To pause or restart an flash® image
Options ψPause or Resume
To select image quality
Options ψQuality and select an item
To rotate the screen 90 degrees clockwise or
counterclockwise
Options ψRotate and select an item
Normal View Full Screen View
11-10
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Confirmation Window & List Options
For items other than window operation options, see
"Data Folder Options" ( P.11-14).
Sorting Files
Sort files in various ways.
ASelect Options Sort by
BSelect an item
To sort files in descending order of dates
Select Date
To sort files by file types
Select Type
To sort files by file names
Select Name
To sort files in ascending order of size
Select Size
To sort files by status of Content Key
Select Activation Status
Tip
To set an image for Wallpaper
Press w (Set as) on Normal View, or in Options of Full
Screen View, select Set as and select Wallpaper.
Tip
When folders are listed
Folders appear at the top of list.
When sorted by Type
Files appear in alphabetical order by file extension
(e.g., doc, jpg, swf, and such).
When sorted by Name
Files appear by file name: numbers ψ alphanumerics
ψ Japanese syllabary
When sorted by Activation status
Files appear as follows:
Unrestricted ψ Nontransferable ψ Copy Protected
(Content Key valid) ψ Copy Protected (Content Key
expired) ψ Invalid Nontransferable
11-11
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Using Files
Using Image Files
Use image files for Wallpaper, Phonebook entries, or
Video Call Substitute Image.
AHighlight a file and press w (Set as)
To set while viewing an image
Highlight a file, press c (View) and press
w (Set as)
BSet File Use
To set as Wallpaper
Select Wallpaper, confirm and press c (Set)
To set as Phonebook entry image
aSelect Caller ID
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry
To set as Video Call Substitute Image
aSelect Still picture
bPress c (Save)
Tip
To edit a still image ( P.7-15)
To create a mobile postcard ( P.7-7)
To print a still image ( P.12-12)
11-12
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Setting Sound File as Ringtone
Change ringtone settings in Normal profile ( P.3-3).
APress c, select Data Folder and select
location to save the file
BHighlight the file and press w (Set as)
CSet ringtone
To set ringtone for Voice Calls
Select Voice ringtone
To set ringtone for Video Calls
Select Video ringtone
To set ringtone for Phonebook entries
aSelect Caller ringtone
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry
To set ringtone for S! Mail/SMS
Select Message alert tone
Setting Video File as Ringtone
Change ringtone settings in Normal profile ( P.3-3).
APress c, select Data Folder and select
location to save the file
BHighlight the file and press w (Set as)
CSet ringtone
To set video file as ringtone for Voice Call
Select Voice ringtone
To set video file as ringtone for Video Call
Select Video ringtone
To set ringtone for Phonebook entries
Select Caller ringtone
Tip
Player Restrictions
Only copy protected MPEG4 AAC, AAC+, or
Enhanced AAC+ files are playable.
11-13
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Setting Flash® file as
Wallpaper
APress c and select Data Folder
Other documents
To set while viewing a Flash® image
Highlight the file, press c (View) and press
w (Set as)
BHighlight the file, press w (Set as)
CSelect Wallpaper
DCheck preview window and press
c (Set)
Saving a vFile
vFile is the standard format to exchange Phonebook
data, etc. via the Internet. 820SC uses vCard
(extension: vcf) format for Phonebook data; also uses
vCalendar (extension: vcs) format for Schedule/To
Do data.
Save a vFile stored in Data Folder to Phonebook,
calendar, or as a scheduled event.
APress c, select Data Folder and select
save location for the vFile
BSelect a file and press c (Register)
Tip
• Restrictions
Only copy protected MPEG4 (mp4, 3gp) AAC, AAC+,
or Enhanced AAC+ files can be set.
11-14
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Data Folder Options
Options vary by file or folder.
For File Viewer or SVG-T/Flash® Viewer, see
"Using File Viewer" ( P.11-6) or "Viewing a
Graphics/Animation with the SVG-T/Flash®
Viewer" ( P.11-9).
Item Description
Edit Edit a still image or Videos ( P.7-15).
Dynamic Effect/
Dynamic effect
list
Create Flash® images using Still
images ( P.7-19).
Full screen view Display Still image in full screen
( P.11-6).
Playback
Playback video files.
When playback display, select Phone
to sound from speaker.
Select A/V headset to sound from
Bluetooth®-compatible devices (stereo
headphone, etc.) ( P.12-7).
Transfer to A/V
headset
Switch sound output to Bluetooth®-
compatible devices (stereo headphone,
etc.) ( P.12-7).
Register to
Phonebook
Export a vCard file to Phonebook
( P.11-13).
Register to
Calendar
Export a vCalendar file to Calendar
( P.11-13).
Send Send file via S! Mail ( P.17-6) or
Bluetooth® ( P.12-6).
mPostcard Create a mobile postcard ( P.7-7).
Zoom Enlarge or reduce still image being
confirmed ( P.11-4).
Browser access Access linked site included in
electronic comic/photo book files.
Sort by Sort files ( P.11-10).
Move Move files from/to 820SC another
folder.
Copy Copy files and paste from/to 820SC
another folder.
Item Description
11-15
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Add to playlist
Add files to Playlist.
Highlight Selected and select to add a
file.
Highlight Multiple and select to add
multiple files at once.
Delete Delete a file/files ( P.11-18).
Delete folder Delete a folder ( P.11-18).
Take photo Activate Camera in Camera mode
( P.11-5).
Record video Activate Camera in Video mode
( P.11-5).
Record sound Activate Voice Recorder ( P.11-5).
Rename Change file name ( P.11-16).
Rename folder Change folder name ( P.11-16).
Show/Hide file
info
In List window for Picture Folder with
thumbnail view, set to display folder/
file name when highlighted.
Item Description
View by
Select List window type for Picture
Folder.
Select List to show folder/file in list
view.
Select Thumbnail view to show folder/
file in thumbnail view.
Create folder Create a new folder ( P.11-16).
Print via Print Still images using the printer via
USB/Bluetooth® connection.
Lock/Unlock Set/release file protection.
Download
content key Purchase or acquire Content Key.
Details Confirm file/folder properties.
Content key
info
Show the list of Content Keys for the
files in Data Folder; manage them by
selecting Delete to delete ( P.11-20)
or Details to check the details.
Item Description
11-16
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Managing Files/Folders
Create Folder
Create sub-folders in Default folders.
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect Default folder to create a
sub-folder
CSelect Options Create folder
DEnter a name
Changing a File Name/Folder
Name
Change the name of a file or a created sub-folder.
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect Default folder and highlight a
sub-folder or a file
CSelect Options Rename folder or
Rename
DEnter a name
Moving a File/Folder
Move a file/folder to another folder or a location
outside folders.
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect Default folder and highlight a
sub-folder or a file
Tip
When a file is locked
You cannot change the file name.
11-17
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
CSelect Options Move
DMove file or folder
To move one file or all files in the same folder
or all created sub-folders
Select Selected or All
To select and move multiple files or created
sub-folders
aSelect Multiple
bCheck files or created sub-folders to move
and press w (Move)
ESelect destination folder Move
here
Copying Files/Folders
Make a copy of a file or folder in another folder or a
location outside folders.
APress c and select Data Folder
BHighlight a folder or a file, select
Options Copy
Tip
To check/uncheck all files or folders at once
Press o (Mark all) or o (Unmark all)
When a file is locked
File cannot to be moved.
When target file/folder with the same name exists
Change file/folder name; enter new name in message
text.
Note
Downloaded files may not appear/play properly if
moved to another device or when a different USIM
Card is inserted in 820SC.
11-18
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
CCopy file or folder
To copy one file or all files in the same folder
or all folders
Select Selected or All
To select and copy multiple files or folders
aSelect Multiple
bCheck files or folders to copy and press
w (Copy)
DSelect destination folder and select
Paste here
Deleting a File/Folder
Delete
APress c and select Data Folder
BHighlight a file, select Options
Delete
CDelete the file
To delete one file
Select Selected ψYes
To delete all files from the same folder
aSelect All
Tip
To check/uncheck all files or folders at once
( P.11-17)
When a copy of a file or folder is pasted to the same
location as the original
The pasted file or folder is saved under another name,
i.e., _001 is automatically added to the name.
When target file/folder with the same name exists
Change file/folder name; enter new name in message
text.
Note
Nontransferable/copy protected files cannot be
copied.
11-19
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
bEnter Phone Password press c (Confirm) and
select Yes
To select and delete multiple files
aSelect Multiple
bCheck files, press w (Delete)
cEnter Phone Password and press c (Confirm)
(If all files are checked)
dSelect Yes
Tip
To check/uncheck files or folders at once ( P.11-17)
If a file is set as Wallpaper or ringtone, or locked
Confirmation appears; select Yes to delete file. When
deleting multiple files, select No to delete unset/
unprotected files only.
When file has Content Key
Confirmation appears; select Yes to delete file and
Content Key.
11-20
Managing Files
(Data Folder)
11
Delete Folder
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect Default folder and highlight a
created sub-folder to delete, select
Options Delete folder
CEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) and select Yes
If no file saved in a sub-folder
Phone Password is not required.
Deleting a Content Key
APress c and select Data Folder
BSelect Options Contents key info
CPerform operations to delete
To delete a Content Key
Select Selected
To delete all Content Keys
Select Delete all
Tip
If a folder contains files set as Wallpaper, ringtones,
or locked/copy protected files
A confirmation message appears. Select Yes to execute
folder deletion. Select No to delete only files without
designated uses or protection, leaving the folder
undeleted.
When file in a folder has Content Key
A confirmation message appears. Select Yes to delete
both the file and Content Key.
External Connections
12-2
External Connections
12
External Connections
Exchange files wirelessly with Bluetooth®-
compatible devices, or connect to PCs or printers via
USB cable.
Bluetooth®
Exchange files wirelessly with Bluetooth® devices or
use a Bluetooth® handsfree device for calls. Use
Bluetooth® to connect PCs and other devices for
Internet access, etc.
Before Using Bluetooth®
Bluetooth® transmissions require Bluetooth®-
compatible devices with the same profiles.
820SC Bluetooth® specifications:
Item Specification
Communication
Standard Bluetooth® Standard Version 1.2
Applicable
profiles
Headset
Handsfree
Serial Port
Dialup Networking
File Transfer
Object Push
Advanced Audio Distribute
Audio/Video Remote Control
Basic Imaging1
Basic Printing
Output Bluetooth® Power Class2
Line-of-signal
distance2Approximately 10 meters or less
12-3
External Connections
12
1 For Printing function only.
2 Varies by radio interference and other conditions.
Bluetooth® Precautions
820SC may not work with all Bluetooth® devices.
File transfers may not possible with some
Bluetooth® devices. Operations, displays or
actions vary by device.
The 2.4GHz band used by Bluetooth® devices is
used by other devices that may reduce transmission
rates/distance.
Use of handsfree devices may create noise
depending on connected devices/the environment.
820SC does not support multiple Bluetooth®
connections.
USB and Bluetooth® cannot be used at the same
time.
Cancel Bluetooth® before connecting USB cable.
Frequency band
used 2.4 GHz
Item Specification Tip
To check Bluetooth® functions available
aPress c and select Settings ψConnectivity ψ
Bluetooth ψBluetooth service
bSelect an item and view the contents
To confirm the device address of 820SC
Press c and select Settings ψConnectivity ψ
Bluetooth ψMy Information
12-4
External Connections
12
Sending & Receiving Files
Send and receive Phonebook entries, My Phonebook
details, Schedule information, Task information, still
images, video, sound files, vFiles, and others.
Activation
Activating Bluetooth® makes 820SC visible to other
devices; appears at the top of Display.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth
Activation
BSelect the setting
Search New Device
Save up to 10 devices to My devices list. Enter the
same Passkey on both 820SC and the device.
Activate Bluetooth® on device beforehand.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth My
devices
BSelect Search new device
CWhen devices appear, select device to
save
DEnter 4-16 digit Passkey and press c
EWithin 30 seconds, enter the same
passkey on the other device
Default
Setting
عOff
12-5
External Connections
12
Tip
• Passkey
The Passkey is a password used to connect
Bluetooth®-compatible devices. When connecting to a
handsfree device, enter the Passkey specified for it.
You are not required to enter the Passkey again for a
registered device.
If authentication with the other device has failed
A confirmation appears; select Yes to retry.
If ten devices have already been registered
A message indicating the device memory is full
appears.
To check Bluetooth® functions available for each
device
aPress c and select Settings ψConnectivity ψ
Bluetooth ψMy devices
bHighlight a device, select Options ψService list
cHighlight an item, select Options ψHelp and view
the contents
To change the name of a registered device
aPress c and select Settings ψConnectivity ψ
Bluetooth ψMy devices
bHighlight a device, select Options ψRename
cEnter a new name
To delete a device from My devices
aPress c and select Settings ψConnectivity ψ
Bluetooth ψMy devices
bHighlight a device, select Options ψDelete ψ
Selected or All
cEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) (In the
case of All only) and select Yes
To search for or register a device from other
Bluetooth®-compatible devices ( P.12-10)
12-6
External Connections
12
My devices list Indicators
Device name is preceded by one of these indicators:
: Personal Computer : Mobile phone
: Handsfree device/Headset
: PDA : Printer : Other
When a connection request appears
If connection request appears, select Yes and enter valid
Passkey within 30 seconds.
Connection requests from saved devices are connected
automatically.
Sending Files
Send via function Options menu. Transfer begins as
soon as receiving device accepts it.
ASelect file to send
To send files from Data Folder
aHighlight the data to send
bIn list window, select Options ψSend ψVia
bluetooth
To send files from other functions (except
Data Folder)
aIn list window, highlight the data to send
bOptions ψSend ψVia bluetooth
BSelect receiving device
If receiving device has not been set
Select Service new device, search for that device
and set it ( P.12-4)
Tip
Sending from Details or Playback windows
Some functions allow sending option from Details/
Playback window.
12-7
External Connections
12
Receiving a File
When connection from the sender is approved, file
reception starts and the received file is saved in Data
Folder.
AWhen confirmation window appears,
select Yes
A/V Headset
Connect Bluetooth®-compatible headphones.
APlay files via Media Player ( P.10-3,
10-8)
BSelect Options Transfer to A/V
headset
CSelect receiver's device
To save dev ice
Select Search new device and save device
(P.12-4)
Print Data Folder Image Files
Connect Bluetooth®-compatible printer to 820SC;
print
Still images/vFiles in Data Folder directly. Set paper
size/number on 820SC.
See printer User Guide for printer operations/
settings.
Tip
While Melody is stopped
aIn Melody Playback window, select Options ψ
Play via ψ A/V headset
bSelect the destination device or Search new device
and search the device to register ( P.12-4)
12-8
External Connections
12
AIn Data Folder list window, highlight
still image/vFile
BSelect Options Print via
Bluetooth
CSelect receiver's device
To register receiver's device
Select Search new device to search and register
(P.12-4)
DPerform operations to set
To set a paper size
Select Paper size and the setting
To set the number of copies
Select Number of copies, enter the number of
copies (1 to 99) and press c
To set the number of pages to print on a sheet
Select Paper per sheet and the setting (1 to 16)
To set whether or not to print the date
Select Date print and the setting
To set whether or not to print a frame
Select Frame and the setting
To set a print quality
Select Print quality and the setting
EPress o (Preview)
FCheck the preview window and press
c (Print)
Accessing Connected Device Files
Access the shared folders and files of the other
party's device. Alternatively, receive or delete data
residing on the other device.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth My
devices
12-9
External Connections
12
BSelect a device
CApprove access on source device
Locations of received files
Received files are automatically saved to Data Folder.
The type of the folder that a file is saved to vary by file
format; for example, JPEG and BMP files are saved to
the Pictures folder and vFiles to the Other documents
folder.
Connecting Handsfree
Save a handsfree device following the steps for
"Search New Device" ( P.12-4) beforehand.
Waiting Connection Request
In the steps given below, 820SC is placed in mode
waiting for a handsfree-device connection request.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth My
devices
BSelect a handsfree-compatible device
When Passkey entry window appears
Enter the same Passkey as is set for the
handsfree device
Answering Mode
If the setting is changed to Automatic a call to 820SC
will be answered without the operation of any keys.
Tip
To receive an accessed file
After Step 3, select a file to receive.
Default
Setting
عNormal
12-10
External Connections
12
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth
Answering mode
BSelect the setting
Handsfree Mode
Select answer settings for calls when handsfree
devices connected.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth
Handsfree Setting
BSelect the setting
Changing Bluetooth® Settings
My Phone's Visibility
Tip
To set the time (Seconds) before automatic
reception
After Step 1, highlight Automatic, select Options ψ
Edit and select the number of seconds to ring before
answering.
Default
Setting
ع Handsfree Mode
Tip
While Private Mode is set
Answer outgoing/incoming calls with 820SC for calls
made with 820SC; answer outgoing/incoming calls
with handsfree devices for calls made with handsfree
devices.
While Handsfree Mode is set
Answer all outgoing/incoming calls with handsfree
devices.
Default
Setting
عOn
12-11
External Connections
12
To activate search and saving from other Bluetooth®-
compatible devices, make 820SC visible.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth My
phone's visibility
BSelect the setting
Bluetooth® Name
Change 820SC name appearing on other devices.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth My
Information
BSelect Bluetooth Name
CModify the name and press c
Default
Setting
ع820SC
12-12
External Connections
12
Secure Mode for Data Transfer
If On, a confirmation appears before transfer.
APress c and select Settings
Connectivity Bluetooth Secure
mode
BSelect the setting
USB Connection
Connect 820SC to a PC via USB cable to transfer
data between the devices. Alternatively, connect a
printer to print still images.
Connecting to a PC
Perform the following:
Transfer 820SC Data Folder files to a PC
Import PC files and save to Data Folder
Perform packet data communications
Before Using USB Connection
Install USB driver and Samsung PC Studio
beforehand. For more about installation, PC
operating environment, etc., see attached CD-ROM
User Guide.
Connecting to a Printer
Connect 820SC to a PictBridge-compatible printer
with a USB cable and print still images directly from
Data Folder. Set a paper size, number of prints, and
other items on 820SC.
For more information about printer operations and
paper setting, see the printer's User Manual.
Default
Setting
عOn
12-13
External Connections
12
Printing a Still Image from Data
Folder
AHighlight an image file in Data
Folder
BSelect Options Print via USB
CConnect 820SC to printer via USB
cable
DSelect printer settings
To set paper size
Select Paper size and select the setting
To set number of prints
Select Number of copies, enter number (1 to 99)
and press c
To set the number of pages to print on a sheet
Select Paper per sheet and select the setting (1
to 16)
To set whether or not to print the date
Select Date print and select the setting
To set whether or not to print a frame
Select Border and select the setting
To set a print quality
Select Print quality and select the setting
EPress c
FCheck the preview window and press
c (Print)
Note
Never disconnect the USB cable during printing.
12-14
Security
13-2
Security
13
Change Phone Password
APress c and select Settings Security
Change phone password
BEnter current Phone Password and
press c (Confirm)
CEnter new 4-digit Phone Password
and press c (Confirm)
DEnter new Phone Password again
and press c (Confirm)
PIN
PINs are security codes for USIM Card. For more
information, see "USIM Card" ( P.1-2).
Changing PIN/PIN2
APress c and select Settings Security
Change PIN code or Change PIN2
code
BEnter current PIN or PIN2 and press
c (Confirm)
CEnter new PIN or PIN2 (4 to 8 digits)
and press c (Confirm)
DEnter new PIN or PIN2 again and
press
c (Confirm)
Default
Setting
ع9999
Note
When PIN lock ( P.13-3) is set to Disable, PIN
cannot be changed.
13-3
Security
13
PIN Lock
To require PIN authentication each time the power is
turned on, set this function to Enable.
APress c and select Settings Security
PIN lock
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
CEnter PIN and press c (Confirm)
Resetting PIN Lock
If PIN or PIN2 is been incorrectly entered three
consecutive times, PIN or PIN2 lock is set,
restricting operations of 820SC. Unlock PIN or PIN2
lock.
AIn PUK Code entry window, enter
PUK Code and press c (Confirm)
BEnter new PIN or PIN2 (4 to 8 digits)
and press c
CEnter new PIN or PIN2 again and
press c
Default
Setting
عEnable
13-4
Security
13 USIM Lock
Activate to disable 820SC unless USIM password is
entered whenever a different USIM Card is installed.
APress c and select Settings Security
USIM lock
BSelect setting and press c (Save)
CEnter a USIM password (4 to 8
digits) and press c (Confirm)
To set Disable
Setting is saved and operation complete.
To set Enable
Proceed to Step 4
DEnter the USIM password again and
press c (Confirm)
Note
For more information about PUK and PUK2,
contact Customer Service ( P.25-25).
If incorrect PUK Code is entered ten consecutive
times, USIM Card is locked (turning 820SC off does
not reset count).
A locked USIM Card cannot be unlocked. Contact
Customer Service ( P.25-25).
Default
Setting
عDisable
13-5
Security
13
Handset Security
Phone Lock
Set Phone lock to Enable; then Phone Password
entry is required each time the power is turned on.
APress c and select Settings Security
Phone lock
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
CEnter Phone Password and press
c (Confirm)
Password Lock
Set Password lock to Enable; Press any key in
Standby; Phone Password entry window appears.
Enter Phone Password to cancel Password lock;
820SC operations are enabled.
APress c and select Settings Security
Password lock
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
CEnter Phone Password and press
c (Confirm)
Tip
USIM password
This is a password dedicated to USIM Card
authentication. If USIM password matches, another
USIM Card may be used in 820SC.
Change USIM password each time the USIM check
setting is set to Enable.
When you forget your USIM password
Insert a USIM Card (with USIM lock set to Enable) in
820SC and execute All reset ( P.13-11).
Default
Setting
عDisable
Default
Setting
عDisable
13-6
Security
13
Privacy
L
ock
Activate to require Phone Password entry to open
All,Messages,Data Folder,Phonebook,Call log or
Calendar).
APress c and select Settings Security
Privacy lock
BCheck the functions to lock and press
w (Save)
CEnter Phone Password and press
c (Confirm)
Activate Secret Mode
Activate Secret Mode to hide Secret Phonebook
entries.
APress c and select Settings Security
Activate Secret mode
BEnter Phone Password and press
c (Confirm)
CSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Tip
When Password lock is canceled
Password lock is automatically set to Disable.
Default
Setting
عUnlock all
Default
Setting
عHide
Tip
Under following conditions, 820SC turns the setting
to Hide;Activate Secret mode is set to Show then
820SC is powered on again.
13-7
Security
13
Mobile Tracker
Activate to receive notification whenever a different
USIM Card is inserted. Enter up to two SMS
addresses via which to receive notification.
APress c and select Settings Security
Mobile tracker
BEnter Phone Password and press
c (Confirm)
CSelect Activation field
DSelect On and press c (Select)
ESelect Recipients field and enter an
address
To select an address from Phonebook
aHighlight To field and select Options ψ
Phonebook
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cHighlight phone number and press c (Select)
To enter a phone number directly
aHighlight To field and select Options ψ
Direct input
bEnter phone number
FPress w (Done)
GSelect Sender field and enter a
sender's name
HPress w (Save)
IPress w (Accept) after checking the
items
Default
Setting
عOff
13-8
Security
13
With a different USIM Card is inserted
If Mobile Tracker is on, SMS notification is sent to
specified address when 820SC is turned on; nothing
appears on 820SC.
Even if Mobile Tracker is off, notification is sent if
Phone Password is incorrectly entered three consecutive
times.
Rejecting Incoming Calls
Automatically reject calls with no Caller ID. Reject
nuisance calls by saving phone numbers to Black
List.
Reject Withheld
APress c and select Settings Call
settings All calls Reject incoming
calls
BSelect Reject withheld field
CSelect the setting and press c
DPress w (Save)
Tip
To delete an address
After Step 5, highlight the address, select Options ψ
Delete
Default
Setting
عOff
13-9
Security
13
Reject Unavailable
Reject/accept calls by callers who are unable to send
caller ID, like International calls from overseas/
transferred calls from landlines.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings All calls Reject incoming
calls
BSelect Reject unavailable field
CSelect the setting and press c
DPress w (Save)
Black List
APress c and select Settings Call
settings All calls Reject incoming
calls
BSelect Black list field
CSet the phone number
To enter a phone number directly
aOptions ψAdd ψDirect input
bEnter phone number
To select a phone number from Phonebook
aOptions ψAdd ψPhonebook
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cSelect phone number
To enter a phone number using Call Log
aOptions ψAdd ψCall log
bSelect the log record
Default
Setting
عOff
13-10
Security
13
DPress C and press w (Save)
Reject Black List
APress c and select Settings Call
settings All calls Reject incoming
calls
BSelect Reject black list field
CSelect the setting and press c
DPress w (Save)
Calls from phone numbers in Black list
Calls are not connected. Caller hears a busy tone.
Missed call appears in Standby. Press w (View) to see
Missed Calls.
Restoring Defaults
Clear Memory
Clear Data Folder, Messaging folders, Phonebook
(Phone) entries, and Calendar entries each or all at
once.
APress c and select Settings Memory
settings Phone memory Clear
memory
BCheck items to reset and press
w (OK)
CEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) and select Yes
Tip
To delete phone numbers from Black list
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bHighlight the phone number to delete, select
Options ψDelete ψSelected or All ψYes
13-11
Security
13
Reset Settings
Clear Saved contents/settings and restore defaults.
However, the following contents are not restored.
APress c and select Settings Memory
settings Phone memory Master
reset Reset settings
BEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) and select Yes
Reset All
Restore 820SC defaults and delete Phonebook
(Phone), Messaging, and Data Folder contents/
settings. Original files and S! Appli are restored.
APress c, select Settings Memory
settings Phone memory Master
reset Reset all
BEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) and select Yes
Setting menu Content not to be reset
Phone settings Time and Date fields in Time & date
Display settings Brightness
Call settings
All callsψReject incoming callsψ
contents saved in Black list
Voice call/Video callψDiverts
Voice callψCall waiting
Call barring
Voice mail
Phonebook
settings
My phonebook details,Category
settings
Connectivity Preferred networks
Security USIM lock,PIN lock,Change PIN
code,Change PIN2 code
13-12
Tools
14-2
Tools
14
Alarms
Wake-up Alarm/Alarms
Save Wake-up alarm and up to four Alarm times.
Add titles to appear at Alarm time. Use Alarm
activation to activate or cancel alarm settings. Set
alarms to repeat on specific days of the week or
everyday.
APress c and select Tools Alarms
BSelect an alarm from Wake-up alarm
to Alarm4
CSelect Alarm activation field
DSelect On and press c
ESelect and set other items as required
Set a name (Wake-up alarm cannot be edited)
aSelect Alarm name field
bEnter the name to set
Set Alarm time
Highlight Alarm time field and enter the time
Set an Alarm sound
aSelect Alert tone field
bSelect the location of sound file, select an
alarm sound and press c
Set Vibrator
aSelect Vibration field
bSelect the setting and press c
Set Alarm volume
aSelect Alarm volume field
bUse s to adjust the volume
cPress w (Play) to check the volume and press
c (Save)
14-3
Tools
14
Set whether to sound repeatedly or once
aSelect Repeat field
bSelect Everyday or Once alarm and press c
Set days of the week for repeat alarm
aSelect Repeat field
bSelect Specify days and press c (Edit)
cCheck the days to set and press w (OK)
Set a snooze procedure
aSelect Snooze field
bSelect the setting and press c
If you do not want to activate Alarm yet
aSelect Alarm activation field
bSelect Off and press c
FPress w (Save)
Tip
When wake-up alarm/alarms are set
appears.
When wake-up alarm and/or multiple alarms have
been set for the same activation time
Wake-up alarm takes priority over Alarm1 to Alarm4.
Among alarms, the last set one takes priority.
Alarm volume settings
Select to adjust volume step by step. Alarm volume
become louder gradually.
14-4
Tools
14
When alarm time arrives
Alarm sounds and a message appears. If set to mute
( P.9-3), handset vibrates. Press any key once to stop
Alarm sound and once more to clear the message.
When Snooze is on
Alarm sounds for one minute, up to six times at the
specified interval, or until Snooze is canceled. If no
handset operations take place, and y, o (End) are not
pressed while alarm sounds, alarm is automatically reset
to sound again at the specified interval. To cancel
Snooze, press y or o (End).
When a call is being initiated or during a call
When 820SCI is engaged (Connecting̖ appears), a
tone sounds and an indicator appears; uncheck Alerts on
call (in Phone sounds setting) to cancel tone. When a
call is being initiated (Dialing̖ appears), a tone sounds
and an indicator appears. Press any key twice to clear
indicator; if Snooze On, press o (End).
While capturing video or recording sound
Alarm sounds when image capturing or recording ends.
Auto Power On
When this setting is active, 820SC automatically
turns on at Wake-up alarm or Alarm time.
APress c and select Tools Alarms
Auto power
BSelect On or Off and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
14-5
Tools
14
At Wake-up alarm/Alarm Time
820SC automatically turns on and Alarm sounds. Press
any key to cancel Alarm ( P.14-4). 820SC returns to
Standby.
Calendar
Displaying Calendar
APress c and select Tools Calendar
Viewing Calendar
View Calendar in Monthly, Weekly or Daily view.
Note
Cancel Auto Power On near electronic devices
employing high precision or low frequency signals,
in places where mobile phone use is prohibited, like
airplanes or hospitals.
Monthly View Window
: Highlighted position
(Date in light blue) : Current
day
Date in red: Holiday/Sunday
Weekly View Window
(In Yellow) : Anniversary
registered
(In Blue) : Schedule registered
(In Green) : Memo registered
(In Red) : Task registered
Daily View
: Schedule
: Anniversary
: Holiday
: Memo
: Task
: Priority
: Alarm set
: Repetition set
14-6
Tools
14
Calendar Window Format
Set first day of the week to Sunday or Monday as
well as the default Calendar window.
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BSelect Options Settings
CSelect settings
Set the first day of week
aSelect Starting day
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Set the default view mode
aSelect Default view mode
bSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Tip
To see previous or later months in Monthly view
Press */#, highlight Year/Month field and press s
To see previous or later weeks in Weekly view
Press */#, highlight Year/Month field and press s
To see previous or later days in Daily view
Press s, *, or #
To view a particular month or week
From Monthly view window or Weekly view window,
change Display by specifying year, month, and day as
follows.
aIn the calendar window, select Options ψGo to
bSelect Date, enter the year, month, and day and
press c
When Today is selected in Step b, the current date is
highlighted on the window of the current month or
week.
Default
Setting
عStarting day: Sunday
عDefault view mode: Monthly view
14-7
Tools
14
Saving New Entries to
Calendar
Scheduled Events
Save a maximum of 100 items.
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BSelect Options Add new
Schedule
CSelect items and set
Set a title
Select Title field and enter a text
Set details
Select Details field and enter a text
Set a starting date
Highlight Start date field and enter a date
Set a starting time
Highlight Start time field and enter a time
Set an ending date
Highlight End date field and enter a date
Set an ending time
Highlight End time field and enter a time
Set an event location
Select Location field and enter a text
Tip
When settings are changed
A change in Starting day is immediately reflected.
Selecting the settings of Default view mode can be
applied when you deactivate calendar and then
reactivate it.
To temporarily change Display mode
In the calendar window, select Options ψView mode
ψ Display mode
14-8
Tools
14
Set an alarm
aCheck Alarm field to select
bHighlight Before field, enter an interval
before Alarm time, use s to highlight Unit
field and switch to an appropriate unit
cSelect Alert tone field, select a location of
sound files and select an alert tone
Set Repeat
aCheck Repeat field to select
bUse s to highlight Time cycle field and
specify the time cycle unit
cHighlight Value field and enter a value
dHighlight Until date field and enter a year,
month, and day to stop repetition
Set Expiry time for a Calendar Event
Use s to highlight Expiry field and switch the
expiry limit
DPress w (Save)
Tip
To simplify Start or Due data entry
Put cursor on the target date on Calendar window
before Step 2 to show that date in Start date or End date
field.
When an event has expired
Event is automatically deleted from Calendar. For
example, if expiry is After 1 year, and repetition is not
set, it is deleted after one year from the event end date.
With repetition set, it is deleted one year after the end
date of the last repetition. To cancel automatic deletion,
set Disable for expiry date.
14-9
Tools
14
Anniversary/Holiday
Register a maximum of 50 anniversaries and 50
holidays.
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BSelect Options Add new
Anniversary or Holiday
CSelect items and set
Set a text
aSelect Text entry field
bEnter text
Set a date
Highlight Date field and enter the date
Set an alarm (Anniversary only)
aCheck Alarm field to select
bHighlight Before field, enter an interval
before the anniversary Alarm time, use s to
highlight Unit field and switch to an
appropriate unit
cHighlight Alarm time field, and enter a time
dSelect Alert tone field, select the location of
sound of files and select an alert tone
Set to repeat every year
Check Repeat every year field
DPress w (Save)
Tip
To make it easier to enter a date
Put cursor on the target date on Calendar window
before Step 2 to show that date in Date field.
14-10
Tools
14
Memo
Up to 20 memos can be registered. Memos can be
registered even while talking ( P.2-8, 6-5).
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BSelect Options Add new Memo
CSelect the memo text box and enter
text
To set the date
Select Date and enter the date
DPress w (Save)
Tasks
Register a maximum of 100 time-limited items and
manage them in a list.
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BSelect Options Add new Task
CSelect items and set
Set a title
aSelect Title field
bEnter title
Tip
To make it easier to enter a date ( P.14-9)
14-11
Tools
14
Set a description of the task
aSelect Task field
bEnter text
To set the starting date
Highlight Start date field and enter the date
To set the due date
Highlight Due date field and enter the date
Set an alarm
aCheck Alarm field
bHighlight Before field, enter a value for how
long before the task starts the alarm should
sound, use s to highlight field of units and
select an appropriate unit
cHighlight Alarm time field and enter the time
dSelect Alert tone field, select the location of
sound files and select an alert tone
Set a priority level
Use s to highlight Priority field and select a
value
DPress w (Save)
Volume of Alarm sound
The volume follows the setting of Tone volume for
Voice Calls; the setting of Voice call in Vibration for
Vibrator.
When the time set for Alarm comes
Alarm sounds and a message appears. To stop Alarm,
press any key. Press c to cancel the message display.
With no action to stop Alarm, a message appears
indicating Missed alarm event. Press w (View) to view
the message.
When a call is being initiated or during a call
During a call or connection (Connecting̖appears),
820SC notifies with a short sound and indicator;
uncheck Alerts on call (in Phone sounds setting) to
Tip
To make it easier to enter a Starting date or Due
date
Put cursor on the target date on Calendar window
before Step 2 to show that date in Starting date and
Due date field.
14-12
Tools
14
notify only by an indicator. When an outgoing call is
being Initiated (Dialing̖appears), 820SC notifies only
by an indicator. Press c to clear an indicator.
Viewing Saved Calendar
Entries
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BOpen a window listing items
To check items of one day
Select a date on Monthly view window or
Weekly view window, or use s to change the
date on Daily view window
To check registered contents by type
Options ψEvent list and select a type
To check the message of a missed alarm
Options ψMissed alarm event
CSelect and view details
Tip
14-13
Tools
14
Editing Calendar Entries
Editing and Saving as New Entries
In addition to edit and update the entries, edit the
entries and save them as new entries.
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BOpen a window listing entries
To open a window listing entries for a single
day
Select a date on Monthly view window or
Weekly view window, or use s to change the
date on Daily view window
To view events by type
Options ψEvent list and select a type
CSelect an item to edit
DPress c (Edit)
EChange the information as required
FPress w (Save) and select New or
Update
Marking a Task as Completed
APress c and select Tools Calendar
BSelect Options Event list Task
CHighlight a completed task, select
Options Completed
To remove the completion mark
Options ψTo do
To check calendar item status
Select Options in Calendar or registered contents list
and Memory status; check the number of savings by
type.
Tip
14-14
Tools
14
Deleting Calendar Entries
AIn Calendar window or saved
contents list, select Options Delete
BDelete the entry
To delete only the highlighted entry
Select Selected ψYes
To delete all entries of current month or week
Select This month or This week ψYes
To delete only entries from a specific period
of time
aSelect Periods
bEnter the start and end dates
cPress c (Delete) and select Yes
To delete all entries or all before the
highlighted date
aSelect All or All past data
bEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) and
select Yes
To sort tasks
In the Task window, select Options ψSort by and
select a sorting type. Classify tasks into completed/
uncompleted ones or sort them by due date or priority.
Tip
To collectively delete multiple registered items
Select registered unnecessary items from a list by type
and delete them collectively.
aPress c and select Tools ψCalendar
bOptions ψEvent list and select the type
cOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
dCheck the items to delete, press w (Delete) and
select Yes
14-15
Tools
14
Calendar Options
Perform the following operations from Options on a
window listing Calendar entries:
Voice Recorder
Record up to 60 minutes; activate from Tools, during
a call, via Data Folder or a Message creation
window.
Item Description
Add new Save a new Calendar entry ( P.14-7).
Send schedule/
Send task
Send Calendar entry via S! Mail
( P.17-6) or Bluetooth® ( P.12-6).
View mode Select a display mode ( P.14-7).
Go to
Display a particular month or week by
changing Monthly/Weekly view
window ( P.14-6).
Event list View events listed by type ( P.14-12).
Delete Delete a Calendar entry ( P.14-14).
Completed/To
do
Set or cancel the task completion mark
( P.14-13).
Sort by Sort tasks ( P.14-14).
Save to Data
Folder
Create a vFile and save it to Other
documents in Data Folder.
Settings Select Calendar Display settings
( P.14-6).
Missed alarm
event
View the message of a missed alarm
( P.14-12).
Print via
bluetooth
Print highlighted schedule event or
task via Bluetooth® printer.
Memory status Check memory usage for Calendar
functions ( P.14-13).
Item Description
14-16
Tools
14
Voice Recorder Window
Control Voice Recorder with Softkeys and
navigation key.
Recording Voice
Recorded voice is saved to Sounds & Ringtones Data
Folder.
APress c and select Tools Voice
recorder
To change the fixed recording time ( P.14-
18)
BPress c (Record)
CPress w (Stop) or continue recording
until the set time runs out
DAs required, press c (Play) to replay
To pause
Press c (Pause)
To resume
Select Options ψRecord
To record voice from Options ( P.14-17)
Recording Window
Navigation key
Elapsed time
Remaining recording time
Playback Window
Navigation key
Elapsed time
Play time
14-17
Tools
14
Playing Voice
Replay a voice file saved in Data Folder.
APress c and select Tools Voice
recorder
BSelect Options My sounds
CHighlight the file and press c (Play)
Voice Recorder Options
Operate listed below from Options before and after
recording. Options's selectable items vary by the
conditions. For more information about available
options after selecting My sounds, see "Data Folder
Options" ( P.11-14).
Changing Voice Recorder
Settings
Default Name
The voice recorded with Voice recorder is saved
under a name such as "Voice 001." "Voice" can be
changed to another word.
Item Description
Record Start recording.
My sounds Call up list of sound files saved in
the My sounds folder.
Send Send a file via S! Mail ( P.17-6) or
Bluetooth® ( P.12-6).
Set as Set voice for ringtone, etc.
Delete Delete a recorded voice file.
Rename Change file name.
Lock/Unlock Set/release file protection.
Details Confirm recorded sound file size,
etc.
Record settings
Select the file name assigned
automatically or the fixed recording
time ( P.14-17).
Default
Setting
عVo i c e
Item Description
14-18
Tools
14
APress c and select Tools Voice
recorder
BSelect Options Record settings
Default name
CEnter a name
Recording Time
APress c and select Tools Voice
recorder
BSelect Options Record settings
Recording time
CSelect a duration and press c (Save)
World Clock
World clock allows you to check the current time all
over the world.
Viewing World Clock
APress c and select Tools World
clock
Tip
If the default name is changed
The naming rule is applied from the next recording.
Default
Setting
ع5 minutes Current time and city name of
Current time and city name of
14-19
Tools
14
Selecting Areas
When you save a second time zone, easily check the
time at that area looking at World clock.
APress c and select Tools World
clock
BUse j to highlight area 1 and use sto
change city name
To set summer time
aPress o (DST)
bCheck the area to set summer time and press
w (Done)
CPress c (Save)
Using Calculator
Arithmetic operations to a maximum of 13 digits can
be performed.
APress c and select Tools Calculator
BCalculate
To enter numbers
Press keys
To enter ,,×, or ÷
Press r, l, u, or d
To display the calculation result
Press c
To enter ., (, or )
Press w (.( )) to toggle symbols
To move cursor left or right
Press * or #
To erase a symbol in a mathematical
expression
Default
Setting
عTokyo, Seoul for both areas
14-20
Tools
14
Place cursor after a symbol to erase and press C
To erase both the mathematical expression
and the calculation result
Press C for 1+ seconds
Converting Currencies or
Units
Convert the currencies for various countries.
Alternatively, convert the units of length, weight, etc.
Converting Currencies
APress c and select Tools Converter
Currency
BSelect Original currency field and
currency
Original currency
Enter the amount in original
Target currency
Converted amount appears
14-21
Tools
14
To replace the original currency with the
target currency
Press o (Reverse)
CSelect Original currency amount field
and enter the amount
To enter a decimal point
Press *
DSelect Target currency field and
currency
EView result in the target currency
To check the exchange rate
aHighlight either of Currency fields and press
w (View Rate)
bPress C to return to the Original window
To change the exchange rate
aHighlight either of Currency fields and press
w (View Rate)
bSelect the base currency to change the rate,
highlight the currency, select Options ψEdit
cEnter the rate and press c (Save)
To add a currency unit
aPress w (View Rate)
bOptions ψAdd Rate
cEnter the currency unit/rate and press c
(Save)
Converting Units
APress c and select Tools Converter
14-22
Tools
14
BSelect Length,Weight,Volume,Area,
or Temperature
CSelect Original unit field and select
the unit
To replace original unit with target unit
Press o (Reverse)
DHighlight Original unit value field
and enter the value
To enter a decimal point
Press *
To enter/delete "-" when converting
temperature
Press #
ESelect target Unit field and select the
unit
FView result in Converted value field
To clear the values
Press w (Clear)
Stopwatch
Use 820SC as a stopwatch; record up to ten lap times
and total time.
APress c and select Tools Stopwatch
BPress c (Start)
CPress c (Lap) to measure a lap time or
w (Stop) to stop time measurement
Original unit
Enter a value in original unit
Target unit
The converted value appears
14-23
Tools
14
Dictionary
Look up English/Japanese dictionaries.
APress c and select Tools Dictionary
BSelect a dictionary
To use English dictionary
Select English dictionary
To use Japanese dictionary
Select Japanese dictionary
CEnter a word to search
DSelect a target word
Interpreter (Japanese)
Enter Japanese text or voice for common phrases
used in airports and other places in English, Korean
or Chinese.
APress c and select Tools Interpreter
BSelect the language
CSelect an item
By voice
Speak the item in menu to 820SC after the beep
By keys
Use a to highlight the item and press c
14-24
Tools
14
DSelect the phrase
By voice
Speak the phrase for inquiry to 820SC after the
beep
By keys
Press w (ࡔ࠾ࡘ࡯ ) to select the item
EHighlight the phrase and press c
To listen the phrase
Press w (㖸ࠍ⡬ߊ)
To listen the phrase again
Press w (࡝ࡇ࡯࠻)
Tip
To play voice prompts
After Step 1, press w (ࡏࠗࠬࠝࡦ)
When appears
820SC could not recognize your voice. Speak clearly
again or say another phrases.
もう一回言って下さい
14-25
14-26
Tools
14
Advanced Functions
15-2
Advanced Functions
15
Calling Functions
Auto Redial
Set to automatically disconnect a Voice/Video Call
initiated to a party that is busy and redial the same
party soon. Automatic redialing repeats up to 10
times until y is pressed or 820SC is closed.
APress c and select Settings Call
settingsAll calls Auto redial
BSelect a value and press c (Save)
International Dial
International Prefix
Set the international code frequently used when
initiating an international phone call.
APress c and select SettingsCall
settings Voice call International
dialInt'l prefix
BEnter an international code
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
When Retry with is set for Video Call
Automatic redialing settings take priority.
When receiver has activated Voice Mail or Call
Forwarding
The call is forwarded and automatic redialing is
canceled.
Default
Setting
ع 010
15-3
Advanced Functions
15
Editing Country Codes
Add a country code or delete an unnecessary one.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice call International
dial Country codes
BPerform operations to add, change,
or delete
To add or change
aHighlight the item to add or change and press
c (Change)
bSelect Country name field and enter the
country name
cHighlight Country code, enter code and press
w (Save)
To delete
Highlight item to delete, press w (Delete) and
select Yes
Earphone call
When Earphone call is On, press switch for 1+
seconds to call specified number.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice call Earphone call
Default
Setting
ع1: Japan 2: KOR 3: GBR 4: ITA 5:
CHE
6: ESP 7: DEU 8: PRT 9: NLD 10:
FRA
11: MCO 12: USA 13: SWE 14: AUS
15: CHN 16: HKG 17: TWN
18 to 20: Unused
Default
Setting
ع Earphone call activate: Off
ع Call number: No list
15-4
Advanced Functions
15
BSelect Earphone call activate
CSelect the setting
DHighlight Call number and perform
operations to save phone number
To enter a phone number directly
aPress c (Select) and select Direct input
bEnter phone number
To select a phone number from Phonebook
aPress c (Select) and select Phonebook
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cHighlight phone number and press c (Select)
To enter a phone number using Call Log
aPress c (Select) and select Call log
bSelect the log record
EPress w (Save)
Tip
To delete a phone number
aPerform Step 1
bPress c (Select) and select Direct input
cPress C for 1+ seconds press c
To change a phone number
aPerform Step 1
bPerform Step 4
cPress c (Save)
15-5
Advanced Functions
15
Handling Incoming Calls
Anykey Answer
Answer Voice Calls using keys other than c (Accept)
or t.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Anykey answer
BSelect On or Off and press c (Save)
Acoustic Shock
Reduces ringer volume to Level 1 for the first two
seconds.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings All calls Acoustic shock
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
Answering a Voice Call when On is set ( P.2-3)
Default
Setting
عOn
15-6
Advanced Functions
15
Active Folder
When On, open 820SC to answer an incoming call.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Active folder
BSelect On or Off and press c (Save)
Side Key Silence/Reject
Use n or b to mute ringer or reject an incoming call.
Select from Reject (disconnect the call) or Silence
(silence the incoming tone).
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Side key
BSelect a value and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
Default
Setting
عSilence
15-7
Advanced Functions
15
Side Key Lock
When On, Side Keys are locked. Avoid accidental
key press when 820SC is inside a bag, etc.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Side key lock
BSelect On or Off and press c (Save)
Simple Search
When Simple search is On, enter numbers in Standby
to search Phonebook entries starting with Reading
name corresponding each number. Then search result
(entry names and phone numbers) list appears.
APress c and select Settings Phone
settings Simple search
BSelect the setting and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
To initiate calls using Simple search ( P.5-12)
15-8
Advanced Functions
15
Idle Shortcuts
Up to nine frequently used functions can be saved;
create own Shortcut Menu. In Standby, press u to
access functions saved to shortcuts.
APress u
BHighlight unsaved function entry box
and press c (Assign)
CSelect the function
DRepeat Steps 2 and 3 to save the
function
Tip
To change functions
aIn Step 2, Highlight the function, select Options ψ
Assign
bSelect Yes and select the function
To sort functions
aIn Step 2, Highlight the function, select Options ψ
Change Order
bUse a to highlight the target function box and press
c (Select)
To delete functions
In Step 2, Highlight the function, select Options ψ
Delete ψYes
To restore defaults
In Step 2, Highlight the function, select Options ψ
Reset ψYes
15-9
Advanced Functions
15
Memory Status
Check the following information:
Available shared memory
Status of SMS and S! Mail mailboxes
Status of memory in Data Folder
Status of Calendar items registered
Status of Phonebooks (Handset and USIM Card)
Alternatively, delete saved entries and/or files.
APress c and select Settings Memory
settings Memory status
BSelect an item to check
Tip
To delete Data Folder, Calendar or Phonebook
content
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bHighlight an item, press c (Select), select Yes and
view an entry
cCheck the fields to delete, press w (Delete) and
select Yes
To delete all contents
After Step c in "To delete the contents," enter Phone
Password, press c (Confirm) and select Yes
To check/uncheck all contents at once
After Step c in "To delete the contents," select
Options ψMark all or Unmark all
When the checked contents contain the contents
that functions or locks are set in
After Step c in "To delete the contents" or the "To
delete all contents" operations, the confirmation
window appears. If you select Yes, the deletion is
performed. If you select No, only files without
functions or locks set are deleted.
15-10
Optional Services
16-2
Optional Services
16
Optional Services
The following optional services are available on
820SC: * This service requires a separate subscription.
Service Description
Call
Forwarding
When you know you will be unable to
answer calls to 820SC, automatically
divert calls to a specified number.
Voice Mail
Divert all or all unanswered calls to Voice
Mail Center; access caller messages via
820SC from within the service area or via
a touchtone phone anywhere.
Call Waiting*
A tone sounds for incoming calls when
the line is engaged.
Put the line on hold to answer or alternate
between lines.
Conference
Call*
Open another line while one is engaged;
toggle lines or talk on all simultaneously.
Add new parties to an existing
conference; talk on up to five lines
simultaneously.
Call Barring Restrict incoming or outgoing calls by
condition.
Caller
Identification
Show or hide your own number when
placing calls.
Note
When Out appears, access services from a
touchtone landline. For details, contact Customer
Service ( P.25-25).
Service Description
16-3
Optional Services
16
Call Forwarding
Set forwarding condition and number, by call type
(Voice Call or Video Call), beforehand, to divert
incoming calls to a specified number.
Activating Call Forwarding
Specify a forwarding number beforehand.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice call or Video call
Diverts
BSelect No reply or Always; view the
current settings
When the settings are acceptable
After viewing, press l to return to the previous
window
Forwarding
Condition Description
No reply
Unanswered calls are diverted after the
specified ring time, or when the line is
busy or 820SC is out-of-range.
Always
820SC does not ring/vibrate for incoming
calls; calls are diverted automatically and
Missed Call does not appear.
Note
Call Forwarding and Voice Mail cannot be used at
the same time.
Activating Call Forwarding cancels Voice Mail.
Call Forwarding is not available when All outgoing
calls or All incoming calls in Call Barring is active
(Call Barring takes priority over Call Forwarding).
16-4
Optional Services
16
CHighlight Forwarding address field
and enter a number
To select a phone number from Phonebook
aHighlight forwarding Address field and
select Options ψPhonebook
bSelect Phonebook, highlight a phone number
and press c (Select)
DFor No reply, highlight Waiting time
field and set a time
EPress c (ON)
Cancel All
Cancel all Diverts services at once.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice call or Video call
Diverts Cancel all
Check Status
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice call or Video call
Diverts Check status
Tip
When Call Forwarding (No reply) is active
While 820SC rings/vibrates, answer a call or press o
(Busy) to forward it.
Tip
To stop Call Transfer service for each forwarding
condition
aPress c and select Settings ψCall Settings ψVoice
call or Video call ψDiverts
bSelect No reply or Always
cPress w (OFF)
16-5
Optional Services
16
Voice Mail
Forward an incoming Voice Call to Voice Mail
Center or a specified number based on preset
forwarding conditions ( P.16-3).
Activating Voice Mail
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice mail
BSelect No reply or Always
CFor No reply, highlight Waiting time
field and set a time
DPress c (ON)
Note
Voice Mail and Call Forwarding cannot be active at
the same time.
Activating Voice Mail cancels Call Forwarding.
Voice Mail is not available when All outgoing calls
or All incoming calls in Call Barring is active (Call
Barring takes priority over Voice Mail). Tip
When Voice Mail (No reply) is active
While 820SC rings/vibrates, answer a call or press o
(Busy) to forward it.
16-6
Optional Services
16
Canceling Voice Mail
Cancel all Voice mail services at once.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice mail Cancel all
Checking Settings
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice mail Check status
Listening to Messages
When a caller saves a Voice Mail message, a
notification appears in Standby and appears at
the top of Display.
While Message Appears
Connect to Voice Mail Center as described below
and follow voice prompts.
APress w (Dial)
To check message details
Press c while message appears
Tip
To cancel Voice Mail by forwarding condition
aPress c and select Settings ψCall settings ψVoice
mail
bSelect No reply or Always
cPress w (OFF)
Notification
16-7
Optional Services
16
While No Message Appears
AEnter 1416 and press t
Incoming Call Notification
SMS is delivered for calls unanswered because
820SC is outside service area or off, or if a caller
saves a message at Voice Mail Center while the line
is engaged.
Incoming Call Notification
AEnter 1414 and press t
To set via landline in Japan (toll free)
Dial 090-665-1414 and press t
To set overseas (charges apply)
Press 0 for 1+ seconds, enter +, enter 81-90-
665-14191 and press t
BFollow voice guidance
Tip
To access caller message from overseas
aPress 0 for 1+ seconds and enter +
bEnter 819066514170 and press t
To delete a message without listening to it
Press o (End).
To clear
Voice Mail indicator disappears when messages are
accessed via 820SC.
16-8
Optional Services
16
Call Waiting*
* A separate subscription is required to use this
service.
This service is only available for Voice Calls.
Activating or Canceling
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Voice call Call waiting
BActivate or cancel the service
To activate
Press c (ON)
To cancel
Press w (OFF)
Receiving a Second Call
When there is an incoming call during a call, you are
notified with a specific interrupt sound and display.
Place the current call on hold and answer the second
call.
AWhen you hear the interrupt sound,
press c (Accept)
BSelect Hold active call
To end current call and answer second call
Select End active call
CPress w (Swap) to toggle the calls
DTo end the current call, press y
To end the call on hold
Options ψEnd ψHeld call
16-9
Optional Services
16
To end both calls at once
Options ψEnd ψAll calls, or close 820SC
Conference Call*
* A separate subscription is required to use this
service.
Talk with a maximum of six parties simultaneously.
New Call
When a new call is connected, first party is placed on
hold.
ADuring a call, select Options New
call and enter number
To use Phonebook
aPress c (Search) and select Phonebook
bHighlight the phone number and press
c (Select)
BPress c (Call)
Tip
When one party ends a call with another on hold
Press w (Retrieve) to talk to the waiting party.
When Call Transfer service or Voice Mail service is
active
When the second call is not answered, it is forwarded
to a forwarding destination or Voice Mail Center.
When the forwarding condition is set to Always, the
Call Waiting service is not available.
16-10
Optional Services
16
Engaged Conference Call
Operations
ACall another party during a call
( P.16-9)
BPress w (Swap) to switch connected
calls
Join
ADuring a call, initiate a call to
another party ( P.16-9)
BSelect Options Join
Tip
To end the call on hold
During a call, select Options ψEnd ψHeld call
To end all calls
During a call, select Options ψEnd ψAll calls, or
close 820SCΤ
When the connected party ends the call while using
Conference Call service
A party on hold remains on-hold state. Switch to the
on-hold party to talk.
Tip
To talk with only one person
During a call, select Options ψSplit and select a caller
to talk to
To end the call for a specific caller
During a call, select Options ψEnd ψSelect
participant, check callers to end and press w (End)
To end the all calls
During a call, press y
When one party ends the call during Conference
Call
Continue talking with remaining parties.
16-11
Optional Services
16
Call Barring
Bar outgoing/incoming Voice/Video Calls or SMS by
the conditions listed below.
Setting restrictions requires Network Password (The
4-digit number dedicated to Outgoing/incoming
service specified at the subscription).
Item Description
Restrict
outgoing
calls
All outgoing
calls
Deactivates initiating calls
and SMS sending, except
emergency calls.
Outgoing Intl
calls
Deactivates initiating
international calls and SMS
sending within your current
location.
Intl except
home
Deactivates initiating
international calls and SMS
sending within your current
location or except Japan.
Restrict
incoming
calls
All incoming
calls
Deactivates reception of all
calls and SMS receiving.
Incoming
when
roaming
Deactivates reception of all
calls and SMS receiving
while outside of Japan.
Note
If incorrect Network Password is entered three
consecutive times, Call Barring service is disabled.
In this case, change Network Password and Center
Access code. For more information, contact
Customer Service ( P.25-25).
If Call Forwarding or Voice Mail is active, All
outgoing calls or All incoming calls cannot be set.
16-12
Optional Services
16
Restrict Outgoing/Incoming
Calls
Restrict outgoing calls and/or Restrict incoming calls
for each type of call (Voice/Video Calls, SMS)/
transmission.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Call barring
BSelect Voice call,Video call, or SMS
and select a restriction type
CEnter Network Password
DSet or cancel call barring
To set
Press c (ON)
To cancel
Press w (OFF)
Cancel All
Canceling outgoing and incoming call is available
for each of call types (Voice and Video Calls, SMS)/
transmission.
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Call barring
Tip
If a call is attempted while restrictions are on
A message appears indicating that outgoing call
restriction is active. The message may appear after a
while depending on service area.
Tip
To check settings
Perform Steps 1 and 2. After checking the settings,
press C to return to the previous window.
16-13
Optional Services
16
BSelect Voice call,Video call, or SMS
Cancel all
CEnter Network Password and press c
Changing Network Password
APress c and select Settings Call
settings Call barring Change
password
BEnter current Network Password in
Old field and new Network Password
(4 digits) in New and Cnf (Confirm)
field, then press c (Confirm)
Caller ID
Show or hide your own phone number when calling
from 820SC.
Show My Number
APress c and select Settings Call
settings All calls Show my
number
BSelect setting and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عBy network
Tip
When set to By network
Automatically set to Show/Hide your number by
current network status.
16-14
Optional Services
16
Adding 186 or 184
Use 186 (Show ID) or 184 (Hide ID) prefixes to
show or hide your number when calling from 820SC,
regardless of the Show my number setting.
AEnter Show ID or Hide ID Prefix
To show Caller ID
Press 186
To hide Caller ID
Press 184
BEnter phone number
CPress t
To initiate a Video Call
Options ψVideo call
Messaging
17-2
Messaging
17
Getting Started
S! Mail
Use this service to send/receive long text messages,
images, videos, other files, and sounds between S!
Mail compatible SoftBank handsets and PCs via e-
mail.
A separate subscription is required to use S! Mail and
receive e-mail.
SMS
Use this service to send/receive short text messages
between SMS-compatible SoftBank handsets using
phone numbers.
Checking for New
Messages
When a message is received in Standby mode,
reception notification appears. The number of
received messages, senders and reception dates/times
appear.
Tip
Retry function
If the other party's handset cannot receive a message
because the power turned off or out-of-range, 820SC
keeps the message saved on Mail Server; then send to
the other party after signal reception recovers stable.
Reception Notification Window
Number of received messages
Sender
Reception date and time
17-3
Messaging
17
APress w (View)
When multiple messages appear
Use s to select the tab and press w (View)
BSelect a new received message
SMS Operations
In SMS window, press Side Keys nb to enlarge/reduce
text font size. Alternatively, press u or d for 1+ seconds
to auto scroll. To stop auto scroll, press any key. Press r
or l to adjust the scroll speed.
Received Message List
SMS Window S! Mail Text
Tip
When a message is received (out of Standby)
or appears at top of Display. When 820SC is
closed, appears on Sub Display ( P.1-11, 1-13).
The icon does not appear with Sub LCD light ( P.8-8)
set to Off.
Received message count
When there are unread messages, the total number of
new and unread messages appears.
Sender information
A phone number or mail address appears. When the
sender has been saved in Phonebook, you will see the
name saved in Phonebook. When an incoming image
has been saved in Phonebook or an incoming image
has been set for the group, the image appears at the
same time. While Secret Mode is set to Hide and
Phonebook Secret Mode is set to On for message
receiver/sender information; sender's name/image does
not appear.
17-4
Messaging
17
3D Pictogram ( P.20-5)
If 3D pictogram is set to other than OFF, when you
check an incoming/unread message (Except S! Mail
that is set for Slide Show or with an attachment), the
message text appears in 3D Pictogram. After 3D
Pictogram display ends or w (Stop) is pressed, Message
window appears. Perform various operations after
Message window appears.
Retrieving Complete Messages
When Home network ( P.20-3) or Roaming ( P.20-
3) is set to Manual, S! Mail is temporarily stored on
Mail Server; part of the received message is sent to
820SC as a reception notification. Retrieve complete
messages from Mail Server.
APress w and select Received msgs
BSelect a message with the rest of it
CPress c (Retrieve)
DSelect complete message
Notification Details
Message Window
17-5
Messaging
17
Message window for S! Mail with an
attachment
The first page shows the file name for the attachment
and the second and subsequent pages show the message.
Use r to read the message or select Options ψPlay to
start Slide Show.
Message window for S! Mail with Slide Show
set
Select Options ψPlay to play the slide. During
playing, press c (Pause)/w (Stop) to pause/stop it. Use s
to manually select pages.
Message window for S! Mail with an inserted
file ( P.17-18, 17-20)
If an image is inserted, the image appears with the
message.
If sound is inserted, select Options ψPlay to play
sound.
If Slide Show is set, sound is played when the page with
an inserted sound appears.
If video is inserted, select Options ψPlay and press o
(Video) to play video.
If Slide Show is set, Video appears at the lower right
and pressing o (Video) plays sound when the page with
video inserted appears.
Message window with a file requiring
purchasing/obtaining Content Key
appears on a page with an inserted file that you
cannot view/play.
Select Options ψDownload content key to view/play
the file.
Using Received Messages
Send a message directly to the sender.
Tip
Received Message list window indicators
: Unread reception notification (Priority: High)
: Unread reception notification (Priority: Standard)
: Unread reception notification (Priority: Low)
: Read reception notification (Priority: High)
: Read reception notification (Priority: Standard)
: Read reception notification (Priority: Low)
To retrieve complete messages from Message list
window ( P.19-2)
17-6
Messaging
17
APress w (Reply) on the Message
window
BCreate a message and press w (Send)
Creating Messages
Two types of messages are available on 820SC: S!
Mail and SMS. The number of characters that can be
sent and entry items are different between these types
(Shown below).
Yes: Available
No: Not available
1 The number of characters that can be sent varies by the
attachment size, etc.
2 Set a maximum of 20 slides in one message.
3 Total size of all kinds of messages (Including address,
subject, text, and attachments).
Tip
Subject display of S! Mail for replies
The subject of a replied S! Mail is prefixed with "RE:"
automatically.
S! Mail SMS
Number of
characters that
can be sent
Approximately
10,000 single-
byte/double-byte
characters1
Approximately
10,000 characters
in one slide2
(Up to 300KB3)
Maximum of 70
single- byte/
double-byte,
Katakana
characters
Maximum of 160
single-byte
alphanumerics
(Up to 140 bytes)
Entr
y
item
Address Yes Yes
Subject Yes No
Attachme
nt
Yes N o
17-7
Messaging
17
Using Mail Art
In S! Mail window, view text/images consecutively like
slides or with a background color ( P.17-13, 17-15, 17-
20).
Procedures
Create messages in the flow shown below. Enter
items other than Destination required.
Creating S! Mail Creating SMS
Enter an address ( P.17-8)
Enter message text ( P.17-11)
Enter a subject ( P.17-11)
Attach/Insert files
( P.17-15, 17-20)
Set any sending options ( P.17-12)
Send the message ( P.17-12)
17-8
Messaging
17
Automatic Change of Message Type
When message creation is started, the message type is
set to SMS; it automatically changes to S! Mail when
one of the following occurs:
Entering mail address as a destination
Entering a subject
Entering characters exceeding the number of
characters that can be sent by SMS
Inserting files on Slide Show page
Attaching or inserting a file
Changing the address type to Cc or Bcc
When the message is modified to allow it to be sent as
SMS, for example, by deleting an attached or inserted
file or a subject, the message type automatically
changes to SMS.
Depending on message creation conditions, it may not
automatically change type. If the mail type is not
changed automatically, change it manually ( P.17-12).
Address
Enter a phone number or mail address for S! Mail or
a phone number for SMS as a message address. Up
to twenty addresses can be entered.
APress w and select Create msg
Tip
To set sending options beforehand ( P.20-2, 20-5)
Message Creation Window
Address field
Subject field
Message field
Text entry field
Attach field
17-9
Messaging
17
BEnter an address
To select an address from Phonebook
aSelect Address field and select From
Phonebook
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cHighlight a phone number or mail address
and press c (Select)
To enter an address directly
aSelect Address field and select Enter
Recipient
bEnter phone number or mail address
To select an address from sent records
Select Address field and select the record
To select an address from a Phonebook
Category
aSelect Address field and select From
Category
bSelect a Category, with/without Address
selection window, highlight an address to
enter and press c (Select)
17-10
Messaging
17
CTo enter another address
To enter an address directly
aSelect Address field
bSelect Entry field and select Enter Recipient
cEnter phone number or mail address and
press w (Done)
To select an address from Phonebook
aOptions ψAdd recipients ψPhonebook
bSearch and select Phonebook
cHighlight a phone number or mail address
and press c (Select)
To select an address from a Phonebook
Category
aOptions ψAdd recipients ψCategory
bSelect a Category; with/without Address
selection window, highlight an Address to
enter and press c (Select)
Tip
To create a message using a template ( P.17-15)
To confirm the entered address
In Step 3, select Options ψRecipient list
To add an address after confirming entered address
aIn Step 3, select Options ψView recipient list
bSelect Entry field and perform operation in the
same way as Step 2
cPress w (Done)
To send a message after confirming entered address
aIn Step 3, select Options ψView recipient list
bOptions ψSend
To change the address type to To, Cc, or Bcc
aIn Step 3, select Options ψView recipient list
bOptions, highlight an address ψChange recipients
ψTo,Cc, or Bcc
To delete an address
aIn Step 3, select Options ψview recipient list
bOptions, highlight an address ψRemove
17-11
Messaging
17
Subject
AIn Message creation window, select
Subject field
BEnter a subject
Message
AIn Message creation window, select
Message field
When Slide Show is set ( P.17-13)
Select Text entry field
BEnter the message
To copy, cut, or paste characters ( P.4-12)
Viewing Address field
When multiple addresses have been saved, and the
number of addresses appear in Address field on
Message creation window.
Note
If shared memory ( P.25-15) is less than 464KB,
you cannot create a message. To create a message,
delete messages.
If shared memory ( P.25-15) becomes low while in
a message creation, you may not be able to save the
message in Drafts.
A message created on 820SC may not appear the
same way on the other party's phone.
Message sent with Subject/Text in Hangul, may
appear as spaces or be deleted on the other party's
phone.
Tip
To copy, cut, or paste characters ( P.4-12)
To set/release the prediction entry function
( P.4-13)
17-12
Messaging
17
Sending a Message
AIn Message creation window, press w
(Send)
Tip
To copy, cut, or paste characters ( P.4-12)
To use an SMS template or Phonebook entry
( P.4-10)
To change the font size of characters being entered
In Step 2, select Options ψFont Size ψSmall,
Standard, or Large
To set/release the prediction entry function
( P.4-13)
To set Slide Show ( P.17-13)
To insert image files, etc. in a Message field
( P.17-16, 17-20)
To view the text in 3D Pictogram
In Message creation window, highlight Message field,
select Options ψ3D Pict.Disp.
Tip
To set sending settings for a message being created
aIn Message creation window, select Options ψ
Sending options
bSelect an item and set it ( P.20-2, 20-5)
cPress w (Apply) or w (Save)
To change the message type
aIn Message creation window, highlight all fields
except Address field
bOptions ψChange to S! Mail or Change to SMS ψ
Yes
17-13
Messaging
17
Slide Show
Open S! Mail window in Slide Show. Text messages,
images, movies, and sounds can be inserted on each
page of Slide Show. Set a maximum of 20 slide pages
in one message.
AIn Message creation window, select
Options Insert Text
BSelect added Text entry field and
enter a message
CTo add a Text entry field for Slide
Show, perform Steps 1 and 2
Changing the Style of Message
Field
Set the font color, font style, interval time for
displaying Slide Show, background color, etc.
Message Creation Window
Slide page No. and display
time
Added Text entry field
Tip
To insert Image,Sound, or Video
Perform operations in "Inserting a File" ( P.17-18).
Alternatively, other files can be inserted in the same
page. But image/video or sound/video cannot be
displayed in the same page.
To delete a Text entry field
aIn Message creation window, highlight Text entry
field
bOptions ψRemove ψYes
To preview Slide Show before sending
aIn Message creation window, highlight a field other
than Address field
bOptions ψPreview
cOptions ψPlay
17-14
Messaging
17
AIn Message creation window,
highlight Message field
BSet options as required
To set background color
aOptions ψEdit style
bHighlight Select page and use s to display All
pages
cHighlight Background colour and use a to
highlight a color
Set the page display
aHighlight a Character entry field to set
bOptions ψEdit style
cHighlight Slide interval and enter a time
Set the font color
aOptions ψEdit style
bHighlight Select page and use s to display All
pages
cHighlight Font colour and use a to highlight
a color
Set a font color for a single slide page
aHighlight a Character entry field to set
bOptions ψEdit style
cHighlight Font colour and use a to highlight
a color
Set font size for all pages
aOptions ψEdit style
bHighlight Select page and use s to display All
pages
cHighlight Font Size and use s to display a
size
To set font size for a single slide page
aHighlight a Character entry field to set
bOptions ψEdit style
cHighlight Font Size and use s to display a
size
To change the display order for text and
images (Videos)
aOptions ψEdit style
17-15
Messaging
17
bHighlight Select page and use s to display All
pages
cHighlight Order item and use s to display
Text-Top or Image (Video)
CPress c (Save)
Templates
Create and send a message using S! Mail or SMS
template.
APress w and select Templates
S! Mail templates or SMS templates
BHighlight an S! Mail or SMS
template
CSelect Options Send
DCreate a message and press w (Send)
Attaching/Inserting Files
A file that can be attached/inserted to an S! Mail is
limited in size to 294KB (except the message
Tip
To preview the style before sending
aIn Message creation window, highlight a field other
than Address field
bOptions ψ Preview
cOptions ψ Play
Note
Edit style or Preview does not appear in SMS
Options.
Tip
To use after viewing an S! Mail template
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bOptions ψView
cOptions ψPlay as required
dOptions ψEdit and send
To register a template ( P.4-15, 18-19)
17-16
Messaging
17
address, subject and message text size). Up to 20
files can be attached to one S! Mail.
Attaching/Inserting a File from
Data Folder, etc. into Message
Field
Attach images, video, and/or sounds saved in Data
Folder to a message, as well as any contents saved in
Phonebook and Calendar (converted as vCard format
or vCalendar format). If you insert a file in Message
Tip
To check the size of a message being created
Select S! Mail as the Type of the message, the message
size appears in the upper-right corner.
Note
Note that some recipients may not be able to receive
attachment or inserted files.
Video files that cannot be sent by S! Mail (File size:
over 294KB, Size: over 176 x 144, Quality: other
than Economy, or etc.) are attached/inserted, the
message indicating attaching/inserting failed
appears.
17-17
Messaging
17
field, display/play the file when you view the
Message window.
Attaching a File
AIn Message creation window, Select
Attach field
BAttach file
To attach file
aSelect Data Folder
bSelect a file from Data Folder
To attach Phonebook data as vCard file
aSelect Phonebook details
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cPress w (Add)
Message Creation Window
(File Attached)
Attach field
Attachment name
17-18
Messaging
17
To attach Calendar items as vCard file
format
aSelect Calendar item
bSelect the items
Inserting a File
AIn Message creation window, select
Options Insert
To insert a file with Slide Show set ( P.17-13)
aIn Message creation window, highlight Text
entry field to insert a file
bOptions ψInsert
Tip
To add a file
Perform Step 1 to 2 in "Attaching a file" ( P.17-17)
To check an attachment
aIn Message creation window, highlight a file in
Attach field and select Options ψView attachment
bSelect a file
If you attach a file
File type indicator and file name appears in Attach
field.
: Image : Sound
: Video : vCalendar
: vCard : File other than above
To replace a file
aIn Message creation window, highlight a file in
Attach field and select Options ψView attachment
bHighlight a file and select Options ψReplace
cPerform Step 2 in "Attaching a file" ( P.17-17)
To delete a file
aIn Message creation window, highlight a file in
Attach field and select Options ψView attachment
bHighlight a file and select Options ψRemove ψ
Selected
To delete all files
aIn Message creation window, highlight a file in
Attach field and select Options ψView attachment
bOptions ψRemove ψAll ψYes
17-19
Messaging
17
BSelect file to insert
To insert an image
aSelect Image
bSelect an image from Data Folder
To insert sound
aSelect Sound
bSelect sound from Data Folder
To insert a video
aSelect Video
bSelect movie from Data Folder
Message Creation Window
(File Inserted)
Inserted file name
Tip
To preview an inserted file
aOptions ψPreview
bOptions ψPlay
If you insert a file
In Message creation window, the icon indicating the
file type, file name, and file size is displayed in Text
entry field. If you inserted an image with no
restrictions on its being displayed, the image will be
shown in reduced size instead of the icon.
: Images that cannot be displayed because of
Content Key has not been purchased or otherwise
obtained
: Sound
: Video
To replace a file
aIn Message creation window, highlight a file in Text
entry field
bOptions ψReplace
cSelect a file
To delete a file
aIn Message creation window, highlight a file in Text
entry field
bOptions ψRemove ψYes
17-20
Messaging
17
Creating & Inserting a File
While creating a message, create a file and insert it.
When Message window is opened, inserted file
appears/plays.
AIn Message creation window, select
Options Create & Insert
To insert a file with Slide Show is set
aIn Message creation window, highlight Text
entry field where a file to be inserted
bOptions ψCreate & Insert
BSelect a creation method and insert
the file
To capture a photograph
aSelect Take picture
bPress c (Take)
cPress c (Add)
To record video
aSelect Record video
bPress c (Record)
cPress c (Save)
dOptions ψAdd to message
To record sound
aSelect Record sound
bPress c (Record)
cPress w (Stop)
dOptions ψAdd to message
To insert a file where another is inserted
A new Slide Show page is added automatically and the
file is inserted. In case of an image file and sound file,
both can be inserted on the same page.
17-21
Messaging
17
Saving Created Messages
Save to Drafts
When message creation is interrupted before
completion, etc., save the message being created to
Drafts.
AIn Message creation window, select
Options Save to Drafts
Tip
If you insert a file
820SC works the same way as the file inserted from
Data Folder to Text entry field ( P.17-19).
To insert a file where another file has already been
inserted
820SC works the same way as the file inserted from
Data Folder to Text entry field ( P.17-19).
To replace or delete a file
Perform operations the same way as the file inserted
from Data Folder to Text entry field ( P.17-19).
Operations activated before and after capturing a
still image ( P.7-6)
Operations activated before and after recording
video ( P.7-11)
Operations activated before and after recording
sound ( P.14-17)
Tip
When C / y / l is pressed on Message creation
window
When C, y, or l is pressed after entering something or
attaching or inserting a file, a message appears asking
whether to finish creating the message. Select Yes to
save the created message to Drafts.
17-22
Messaging
17
Save as a Template
By saving a message with fixed contents, etc. as an
S! Mail templates, new S! Mail can be easily created
and sent.
AIn Message creation window,
highlight Attach or Text entry field
BSelect Options Save as template
Note
Save to Drafts appears in Options after address,
subject or text has been entered or a file is attached/
inserted.
Note
Saved as template appears in Options only when a
subject is entered or the message is longer than
SMS, or when a file is inserted.
Messaging Folders
18-2
Messaging Folders
18
Viewing Messages
Five mailboxes are created on 820SC.
Message Lists
From list of Received msgs or Unsent msgs, view the
messages.
APress w
BSelect Received msgs or Unsent msgs
Mailbox Message type
Received msgs Received messages.
Drafts Message drafts saved before
completion.
Unsent msgs Messages unsent because of failure or
cancellation, or waiting to be sent.
Sent msgs Messages already sent.
Templates S! Mail or SMS saved as templates.
Tip
To check message memory status
aPress w
bSelect Memory status
cSelect SMS,S! Mail (By count), or S! Mail (By size)
To create a personal folder in Received msgs
( P.18-15)
Note
When adding a new SMS to Drafts, Unsent msgs, or
Sent msgs cause the maximum number of allowed
message to be exceeded, the oldest SMS is deleted
automatically.
Received Message List
18-3
Messaging Folders
18
From a personal folder in Received msgs
Select a folder; then Phone Password entry window
appears, enter Phone Password and press c
(Confirm)
CSelect a message
Message List Window
The following information appears in lists for each
Messaging folder.
Tip
In Message window, press * or #
Switch between previous and next window.
When pressing Side Keys nb in SMS window
Press Side Key n to enlarge font size by two levels;
press Side Key b to reduce font size by two levels
To view a sent message
aIn Step 2, select Sent msgs
bHighlight a message, select Options ψView
To view S! Mail details
In Step 3, highlight a message, select Options ψ
Details
Received Message List
Message type icon
Copy protected file indicator
Sender or recipient
Reception date
Subject or the top of the message
Message size
18-4
Messaging Folders
18
Tip
Received Message Indicators
: Unread S! Mail (Priority: High)
: Unread S! Mail (Priority: Standard)
: Unread S! Mail (Priority: Low)
: Unread S! Mail (Priority: High; Video and/or
sound inserted)
: Unread S! Mail (Priority: Standard; Video and/or
sound inserted)
: Unread S! Mail (Priority: Low; Video and/or
sound inserted)
: Read S! Mail (Priority: High)
: Read S! Mail (Priority: Standard)
: Read S! Mail (Priority: Low)
: Read S! Mail (Priority: High; Video and/or sound
inserted)
: Read S! Mail (Priority: Standard; Video and/or
sound inserted)
: Read S! Mail (Priority: Low; Video and/or sound
inserted)
: Unread reception notification (Priority: High)
: Unread reception notification (Priority: Standard)
: Unread reception notification (Priority: Low)
: Read reception notification (Priority: High)
: Read reception notification (Priority: Standard)
: Read reception notification (Priority: Low)
: Unread SMS
: Read SMS
: Unread SMS (saved in USIM Card)
: Read SMS (saved in USIM Card)
: Unread S! Mail Delivery Report
: Read S! Mail Delivery Report
: Unread SMS Delivery Report
: Read SMS Delivery Report
: Receiving S! Mail
Draft Message Indicators
: S! Mail (Priority: High)
: S! Mail (Priority: Standard)
: S! Mail (Priority: Low)
: S! Mail (Priority: High; Video and/or sound
inserted)
: S! Mail (Priority: Standard; Video and/or sound
inserted)
: S! Mail (Priority: Low; Video and/or sound
inserted)
: SMS
18-5
Messaging Folders
18
Message Window Operations
Saving to Phonebook
Save phone number/mail address of the sender/
recipient to Phonebook while viewing Message
window (Received)/Reception notification window.
AIn Message window, select Options
Add to Phonebook Phone or USIM
BSelect New or Update
To save as a new entry
Select New
To save to an existing entry
aSelect Update
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
CSelect an icon
DSave other items ( P.5-4)
Unsent Message Indicators
: S! Mail
: S! Mail (Video and/or sound inserted)
: SMS
: Sending S! Mail
Sent Message Indicators
: S! Mail
: S! Mail (Video and/or sound inserted)
: SMS
: SMS (saved in USIM Card)
Copy Protected file Indicators
Attached/inserted Copy protected file indicators
: Transferable, Content Key has already been
purchased
: Transferable, Content Key has not been purchased
or otherwise obtained
: Nontransferable, Content Key has already been
purchased
: Nontransferable, Content Key has not been
purchased or otherwise obtained
While Secret Mode is set to Hide
Phonebook Secret Mode is set to On for message
receiver/sender information; only the number or email
addresses appear (instead of the name).
18-6
Messaging Folders
18
EPress w (Save)
Saving as an S! Mail Template
Save received or sent S! Mail as an S! Mail template.
AIn Message window, select Options
Save as S! Mail template
Message Window Options
Note
When an underlined phone number, mail address
or URL is highlighted in a message window, Add to
Phonebook does not appear in Options.
Tip
If a message appears indicating name duplication
aPress c
bPress c (Select) and enter the name
cPress w (Save)
When a name entry window has opened
aPress c (Select) and enter the name
bPress w (Save)
Note
While viewing S! Mail sent via PC, etc., Save as S!
Mail template does not appear in Options.
Item Description
Play Play Slide Show, inserted video, or
sound ( P.17-5).
Retrieve Receive subsequent part of the notified
message.
Reply Reply to the sender of the reception
notification.
Reply to all Send reply to all entered S! Mail
recipients.
Forward Forward received message.
Download
content key Purchase or acquire Content Key.
Delete Delete displayed messages.
Save as S! Mail
template
Add displayed S! Mail as an S! Mail
template ( P.18-6).
18-7
Messaging Folders
18
Replying to a Message
APress w and select Received msgs
BHighlight message, select Options
Reply
To reply to all recipients entered in the S!
Mail
Highlight message, select Options ψ Reply to
all
CCreate a message and press
w (Send)
Save items Save files attached or inserted in an S!
Mail to Data Folder ( P.18-14).
Add to
Phonebook
Save number or mail address to
Phonebook or USIM Card Phonebook
( P.18-5).
Details Confirm S! Mail size, etc.
3D Pict. Disp. Display a message in 3D Pictogram
( P.20-5).
Move to Phone/
USIM
Move an SMS received or being sent
to handset or USIM Card ( P.18-18).
Item Description
Tip
Reply subject prefix
"RE:" automatically appears before S! Mail Reply
subject.
When Reply with text is On
Received message text automatically appears two lines
below Reply text in Text entry field.
Note
If shared memory ( P.25-15) is less than 464KB,
you cannot reply to a message. To reply to the
message, delete messages.
18-8
Messaging Folders
18
Forwarding a Message
Forward a received or sent message to another
recipient.
APress w and select Received msgs or
Sent msgs
BHighlight message, select Options
Forward
CCreate a message and press
w (Send)
Sending from Drafts
APress w and select Drafts
BHighlight the message and press
w (Send)
When Send does not appear
aPress c (Edit)
bEnter address and press w (Send)
Tip
The subject of forwarded messages
The subject of a forwarded S! Mail is prefixed with
"FW:" automatically.
Note
If shared memory ( P.25-15) is less than 464KB,
you cannot forward a message. To forward the
message, delete messages.
18-9
Messaging Folders
18
Sending from Unsent
Messages
Send messages directly from Unsent Messages.
APress w and select Unsent msgs
BHighlight the message and press
w (Send)
To send after modifying
aHighlight the message, select Options ψ
Edit
bEdit the message and press w (Send)
Deleting a Message
Deleting Specified Message(s)
Delete multiple specified messages. Alternatively,
specify and delete saved templates.
APress w
BSelect a mailbox
To delete a saved S! Mail or SMS templates
Select Templates ψS! Mail templates or SMS
templates
CDelete a Message or Template
To delete one message or template
aHighlight the message or template
bOptions ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
To delete multiple messages or templates
aOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
bCheck a message or template to delete
cRepeat b to check all of the target messages
or templates
dPress w (Delete) and proceed to f when all
are not checked
eEnter Phone Password and press c (Confirm)
fSelect Yes
18-10
Messaging Folders
18
Designating & Deleting a
Mailbox
APress w to select Settings Delete all
BCheck a mailbox to delete
CRepeat Step 2 to check all target
mailboxes
DPress w (Delete)
EEnter Phone Password, and press
c (Confirm) to select Yes
Tip
To view the contents of multiple messages or S!
Mail templates while selecting them
aRepeat Steps 1 and 2
bOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
cHighlight message or S! Mail template, select
Options ψView
To collectively select/deselect multiple messages or
S! Mail templates
aRepeat Steps 1 and 2
bOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
cOptions ψMark all or Unmark all
To collectively select/deselect multiple SMS
templates
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
cPress o (Mark all) or o (Unmark all)
Note
While highlighting an S! Mail template designated
as default, Delete does not appear in Options.
18-11
Messaging Folders
18
Deleting All Messages from a
Mailbox
Delete saved templates all at once.
APress w
BSelect a mailbox
To delete an S! Mail or SMS template
Select Templates ψS! Mail templates or SMS
templates
CSelect Options Delete All
DEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) and select Yes
Linked Information
If Message window or Notification details window
contains an underlined number, mail address, or
URL; save it to Phonebook or use it to place a call,
send messages, save bookmark, or access the site.
As linked information, following number of
characters can be recognized for each S! Mail Font
size setting:
Maximum of 45 lines (1,035 characters) for
Standard,
54 lines (1,026 characters) for Large, and 41 lines
(1,025 characters) for Small.
Note
Personal folders cannot be deleted by this
operation. To delete Personal folders, select
Messaging Settings Delete all
You cannot delete the S! Mail template designated
as the default.
18-12
Messaging Folders
18
Saving to Phonebook
AIn Message window, select a phone
number, mail address, or URL and
select Add to phonebook Phone or
USIM
BCreate a new entry or update an
existing one
To save as a new entry
Select New
To save to an existing entry
aSelect Update
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
CSelect an icon
DSave other items ( P.5-4)
EPress w (Save)
Saving as a Bookmark
AIn Message window, select a URL and
select Bookmark
BPress c (Select) to enter a subject and
press w (Save)
Initiating a Call, Sending a
Message, or Accessing the Web
Use phone number/mail address/URL information in
Message window or Notification details window.
AIn Message window, follow steps
below
Note
If URL is selected, USIM is unselectable in Step 1.
18-13
Messaging Folders
18
To initiate a Voice Call
Select a phone number and select Voice call
To initiate a Video Call
Select a phone number and select Video call
To send a message
aSelect a phone number or mail address and
select Create msg
bCreate a message and press w (Send)
To access the Web
Select URL and select Go to URL
Using an Attachment
Viewing an Attachment
Open images/play sounds attached to S! Mail. For
vCard/vCalendar, open Details to see contents.
ASelect a file and select Open file
Tip
Operations in Notification details window
Phone number/mail address/URL information except
in From (other party's phone number) can be used.
Tip
To save a file in Data Folder directly
In Message window, select a file ψSave items
To save vCard/vCalendar to Phonebook/Calendar
directly
In Message window, select a file ψRegister to
Phonebook or Register to Calendar
To register vCard/vCalendar to Phonebook/
Calendar after viewing
aPerform Step 1
bPress c (Register)
18-14
Messaging Folders
18
Saving Attachments to Data
Folder
Save S! Mail attachment/inserted files to 820SC.
AIn Message window, select Options
Save items
BSelect file(s)
To select and save one file
aHighlight a file
bPress c (Select) or select Options ψSelected
To select and save multiple files
aOptions ψMultiple
bCheck the files to save
cRepeat b to check all target files
dPress w (Save)
To save all files
Options ψAll
When a file requiring Content Key is attached
After Step 1, a message appears and file does not open.
To view the file, select Save items in Step 1 to save and
purchase/obtain Content Key from Data Folder
( P.11-14).
When an attachment has a restriction (one play
only)
After Step 1, one play only message appears.
Tip
To select or deselect multiple files at once
aIn Step 2, select Options ψ Multiple
bPress o (Mark all) or o (Unmark all)
If message appears indicating name already exists
aPress c
bPress c (Select) and change the file name
cPress w (Save)
Note
When a file is highlighted in Message window, Save
items does not appear in Options.
18-15
Messaging Folders
18
Managing Folders
Create personal folders in Received msgs; organize
messages by message type. Active Security for
personal folders.
Create Folder
APress w and select Received msgs
BSelect Options Create folder
CEnter a name
Edit Folder
Change personal folder names.
APress w and select Received msgs
BSelect Options Edit folder
CEnter a name
Security ON/OFF
Activate Security to require Phone Password entry to
open a personal folder.
APress w and select Received msgs
BHighlight the personal folder, select
Options Security ON/OFF
CEnter Phone Password and press c
(Confirm), then select Yes
Tip
Secure Folders
appears.
When a Secure Folders is selected
Select personal folders; Phone Password entry window
appears. Enter Phone Password and press c; Message
list window in the personal folder appears.
18-16
Messaging Folders
18
Moving Messages
APress w and select Received msgs
To move messages from a personal folder
Select that folder
BHighlight message, select Options
Move this
CSelect the destination folder
To return messages to Received msgs
Select Received msgs
Delete Folder
APress w and select Received msgs
BHighlight the personal folder, select
Options Delete folder Yes
To open a secure folder
Enter Phone Password and press c (Confirm)
CSelect Yes
From Message List
Saving to Phonebook
APress w and select Received msgs,
Unsent msgs or Sent msgs
BHighlight message, select Options
Add to Phonebook
18-17
Messaging Folders
18
CSelect a phone number or mail
address and select Phone or USIM
DSelect saving method to create a new
entry or update an existing entry
To save as a new entry
Select New
To save to an existing entry
aSelect Update
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
ESelect an icon
FEnter additional items as required
( P.5-4)
GPress w (Save)
Sorting Messages
Available sorting types vary by Mailbox/Message
list.
AIn Message list window, select
Options Sort by
BSelect an item
To sort in descending order of date
Select Date
To sort by sender
Select Sender
To sort by recipient
Select Recipient
To view read and unread messages separately
Select Unread to read or Read to unread
18-18
Messaging Folders
18
To view messages separately by type
Select Message type
To sort by subject
Select Subject
To sort in descending order of message size
Select Size
Move to Phone/Move to USIM
Move received SMS or sent SMS.
Save up to ten messages to USIM Card.
APress w and select Received msgs or
Sent msgs
BMove messages
To move from USIM Card to 820SC
aHighlight an SMS saved on USIM Card
bOptions ψMove to phone
To move from 820SC to USIM Card
aHighlight an SMS saved in USIM Card
bOptions ψMove to USIM
Tip
Listing order when selecting Message type
SMS ψ S! Mail (Including message notification) ψ
SMS saved in USIM Card.
Sender, Recipient, or Subject list order
Listed in the order of single-byte symbol ψsingle-
byte number ψ single-byte alphabet ψsingle-byte
Katakana ψdouble-byte symbol ψdouble-byte
Hiragana ψdouble-byte Katakana ψKanji ψ
double-byte number ψ double-byte alphabet. But if
Subject is selected, messages with no subject are listed
at the top.
18-19
Messaging Folders
18
Saving an S! Mail Template
For more information about saving an SMS template,
see "SMS Templates" ( P.4-15).
APress w and select Templates
S! Mail templates
BSelect Options Add new
CSelect Subject field or Text entry field
and enter a subject or message
DPress w (Save)
Tip
Message List SMS Indicators
: Unread SMS
: Read SMS
: Unread SMS (USIM Card)
: Read SMS (USIM Card)
: Sent SMS
: Sent SMS (USIM Card)
When moving received SMS from personal folders
to USIM Card
A confirmation appears. Select Yes to complete the
move.
Tip
To view an S! Mail template being created
In Step 3, select Options ψPreview
To display and view an S! Mail template
In Step 2, highlight S! Mail template, select Options ψ
View
To modify an S! Mail template
aIn Step 2, select a registered S! Mail template and
perform modification operation
bPress w (Save)
To delete an S! Mail template
Perform the same operation as for a message ( P.18-
9).
To copy, cut, or paste characters ( P.4-12)
To use contents of an SMS template or Phonebook
( P.4-10)
18-20
Messaging Folders
18
Message List Options
To change font size
aIn Step 3, select Text entry field, select Options ψ
Font Size
bSelect any of Small,Standard, or Large
To turn predictive entry on/off ( P.4-13)
Setting Slide Show/inserting a file
aIn Step 3, select Options ψInsert or Create &
Insert
bPerform setting, attaching, or inserting operation
( P.17-13, 17-18, 17-20)
To view the text in 3D Pictogram
In Step 3, highlight Text entry field, select Options ψ
3D Pict.Disp.
Item Description
Retrieve Retrieve complete S! Mail from the
Server.
Reply Reply to the sender ( P.18-7).
Reply to all Send reply to all entered S! Mail
recipients ( P.18-7).
Forward Forward received message ( P.18-8).
Move this Move received mails to a personal
folder ( P.18-16).
Create folder Create a personal folder ( P.18-15).
Edit folder Change personal folder name ( P.18-
15).
Security On/Off
With Security setting On, enter Phone
Password to check mails in a personal
folder ( P.18-15).
Delete folder Delete a personal folder ( P.18-16).
View Open sent messages or S! Mail
templates ( P.18-3, 18-19).
Edit Edit unsent message ( P.18-8).
Delete Delete messages or templates ( P.18-
9, 18-11).
Move to phone/
Move to USIM
Move SMS between 820SC and
USIM Card ( P.18-18).
Sort by Sort messages ( P.18-17).
Add to
Phonebook
Save number or mail address to
Phonebook or USIM Card Phonebook
( P.18-16).
Item Description
18-21
Messaging Folders
18
Details Check memory status in a personal
folder or confirm S! Mail size, etc.
Cancel
retrieving
Stop message retrieval from Mail
Server.
Send Send message using S! Mail template
or SMS template ( P.17-15).
Add new Save a new S! Mail template or SMS
template ( P.4-15, 18-19).
Item Description
18-22
Server Mail
19-2
Server Mail
19
Message List
View Mail Server message list. Retrieve, forward, or
delete messages.
Acquire Mail List
APress w and select Server mail box
BSelect Acquire Mail List
Download
APress w and select Server mail box
BSelect Mail List
CHighlight the message, select Options
Download
Tip
To check Mail Server usage state
aSelect Server mail volume in Step 2
bPress c (Update) and select Yes to update to the
latest information
Tip
To receive all messages from Message list window
In Step 2, select Retrieve All Mail
19-3
Server Mail
19
Delete
APress w and select Server mail box
BSelect Mail List
CDelete unwanted messages
To delete one message
aHighlight a message
bOptions ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
To delete multiple messages
aOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
bCheck a message to delete
cRepeat b to check all target messages to
delete
dPress w (Delete) and go to f if unmarking
all
eEnter Phone Password and press c (Confirm)
fSelect Yes
To delete all messages
aOptions ψDelete ψAll
bEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) and
select Yes
Tip
To select/deselect multiple messages at once
aPerform Steps 1 and 2
bOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
cOptions ψMark all or Unmark all
19-4
Server Mail
19
Remote Forward
Forward a message from the Mail Server to another
address. Contents except the address are sent without
modification.
APress w and select Server mail box
BSelect Mail List
CHighlight message, select Options
Remote Forward
DEnter an address
To directly enter an address
aSelect Entry field and select Enter Recipient
bEnter a phone number or mail address
To enter an address using a log
Select Entry field and select a displayed log
entry
To select an address from Phonebook
aSelect Entry field and select From
Phonebook
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cHighlight a phone number or mail address
and press w (Select)
To select an address via Phonebook Category
aSelect Entry field and select From Category
bSelect a Category, with/without an Address
selection window, highlight an address and
press w (Select)
19-5
Server Mail
19
ESelect Options Send Tip
Message subject
Forwarded message Subject is automatically prefixed
with "FW:".
To set other sending options for a message
aIn Step 5, select Options ψSending options
bSelect an item and perform operations to set
( P.20-2)
cPress w (Apply)
To delete an address
In Step 5, highlight a recipient, select Options ψ
Remove
To change address type to To, Cc, or Bcc
aIn Step 5, highlight a recipient, select Options ψ
Change recipients
bSelect any of To,Cc, or Bcc
19-6
Other Message Settings
20-2
Other Message Settings
20
Customizing Handset
Address
Change your mail address (alphanumerics before @)
used for sending and receiving S! Mail to/from PC,
etc. The default account name consists of random
alphanumerics.
APress w and select Settings
S! Mail Mail Address setting
BFollow onscreen instructions
S! Mail Settings
Sending Settings
Set Sending options. Alternatively, set options for
each
S! Mail to send ( P.17-12).
APress w and select Settings
S! Mail Sending options
BSelect an item and set
Message priority
aSelect Priority
bSelect a level and press c
Mail Server Retention Period (before expiry)
aSelect Expiration
bSelect an item and enter a time if you
selected Custom time (Hour)
cPress c
Mail Server Retention Period (before
delivery)
aSelect Delivery
bSelect an item and press c
Default
Setting
عPriority: Normal عExpiration: Maximum
عDelivery: Immediately
عRequest delivery report: Unchecked
20-3
Other Message Settings
20
Delivery report request
Check Request delivery report
CPress w (Save)
Receiving Settings
Set receiving options.
APress w and select Settings
S! Mail Receiving options
Tip
When retention set in Expiration expires
The S! Mail is deleted automatically from the Mail
Server.
When retention is set in Delivery
When the specified time has elapsed, the S! Mail is
sent from the Mail Server.
When Request delivery report is checked
When an S! Mail is sent from the Mail Server, a
distribution report is sent to your handset.
Default
Setting
عHome network: Auto download
عRoaming network: Manual
20-4
Other Message Settings
20
BSelect a receiving method
To set the receiving method to use in Japan
aSelect Home network
bSelect an item and press c
To set the receiving method while overseas
aSelect Roaming network
bSelect an item and press c
CPress w (Save)
Message Size
Cancel outgoing messages exceeding specified size.
APress w and select Settings
S! Mail Message size
BSelect an item and press c (Save)
Default Style
Set font color, font style, background color, and Slide
Show time intervals. Alternatively, change display
settings for each S! Mail sent ( P.17-13).
Tip
Home network and Roaming network Items
Auto download: Receive automatically.
Manual: Receive only reception notification.
Default
Setting
ع300KB
Default
Setting
عFont color: Black عFont size: Large
عBackground color: White
عSlide interval: Custom time (3 seconds)
20-5
Other Message Settings
20
APress w and select Settings
S! Mail Default style
BSet Options
Font color
aSelect Font color
bUse a to highlight a color and press c
To set a font size
aSelect Font Size
bSelect an item and press c
Background color
aSelect Background color
bUse a to highlight a color and press c
Slide Show time intervals
aSelect Slide interval
bSelect an item, with Custom time, enter a
time
cPress c
CPress w (Save)
SMS Settings
Set Sending options. Alternatively, set options for
each SMS message ( P.17-12).
APress w and select Settings SMS
BSet Options
Request a delivery report
Check Delivery report
Change character encoding
aSelect Character support
bSelect an item and press c
CPress w (Save)
Default
Setting
عDelivery report: Unchecked
عCharacter support: Automatic
20-6
Other Message Settings
20
3D Pictogram Settings
Animate text, pictograms or emoticons in message
text.
Activate/cancel 3D Pictogram; set background color/
speed.
APress w and select Settings
3D pictogram
BSet Options
3D Pictogram
aSelect Display type
bSelect an item and press c (Save)
Background & Font color
aSelect Background
bPress s, select a pattern and press c (Save)
To set speed
aSelect Running speed
bSelect an item and press c (Save)
Tip
When Delivery report is checked
When an SMS is sent from the Mail Server, a delivery
report is sent to your handset.
Default
Setting
عDisplay type: OFF
عBackground: Pattern 1
عRunning Speed: Normal
Tip
Display type Items
Always: Use 3D Pictogram when viewing every
message.
New mails only: Use 3D Pictogram only when viewing
an unread message.
OFF: Not use 3D Pictogram.
20-7
Other Message Settings
20
Reply with text
Activate to include original message text in Reply.
APress w and select Settings Reply
with text
BSelect an item and press c (Save)
Note
Mail attachments, such as slide shows, may not
appear properly in 3D Pictogram.
Default
Setting
عOff
Tip
Reply with text Items
On: Reply with text including received message text.
Off: Reply with text not including received message
text.
20-8
Other Message Settings
20
Mobile Internet
21-2
Mobile Internet
21
Getting Started
Web
Access Mobile Internet or Internet sites from 820SC.
Browse sites or download image or sound files, etc.
A separate subscription is required for Web service.
Accessing via Yahoo! Keitai Main Menu
Select Yahoo! Keitai main menu items to access
various content.
Internet Accessing
Enter a URL and access pages.
SSL/TLS
Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) and Transport Layer
Security (TLS) are encryption protocols for secure
Internet transmissions of important/sensitive
information (credit card numbers, etc.) and
authentication. Confirm electronic certificates saved
on 820SC ( P.22-14, 23-4).
SSL/TLS Precautions
When a security notice appears, subscribers must decide
for themselves whether or not to open the page.
Opening secure pages constitutes agreement to the
terms of usage. SOFTBANK MOBILE Corp., VeriSign
Japan K.K., Betrusted Japan Co., Ltd., Entrust Japan
Co., Ltd GeoTrust Japan Inc., RSA Security Inc. and
SECOM Trust Systems Co., Ltd. are not liable for
damages associated with SSL/TLS use.
Cache
Retrieved Mobile Internet pages are temporarily
saved here. Cache remains even after a session ends
or 820SC is turned off. When full, oldest pages are
automatically deleted to make room for new ones.
When a saved page is opened again, it may open
from Cache. For the latest version, reload the page
(P.22-13).
21-3
Mobile Internet
21
Getting Online
Yahoo! Keitai Main Menu
Access Mobile Internet sites via Yahoo! Keitai main
menu.
APress o
BSelect an item
Enter URL
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Enter URL
BSelect URL field and enter a URL
CPress w (Go to)
Tip
To manually delete Cache contents ( P.23-4)
When another USIM Card is inserted into 820SC
Cache contents are automatically deleted.
When a page with an expiry date is saved
Page is automatically deleted upon expiry.
Tip
When accessing Mobile Internet for the first time
After Step 1, Time & date settings window appears; set
time & date to display Information window.
Tip
To save the entered URL as a bookmark
aIn Step 2, check Add bookmark
bSelect Title field and enter title
cPress w (Go to)
To access a page from the access history ( P.22-11)
21-4
Mobile Internet
21
Page Window Operations
Operations on pages are as follows.
Scrolling
Scroll bar appears when page content extends
beyond current view.
d/r: Scroll down by one line
When a horizontal scroll bar appears, use r to
scroll right
u/l: Scroll up by one line
When a horizontal scroll bar appears, use l to
scroll left
Side Key b: Scroll page down by multiple lines
Side Key n: Scroll page up by multiple lines
Moving Cursor
When selecting an item such as link, move cursor to
that item.
d/r: When items are listed vertically, move cursor
down
When the page is already scrolled to the bottom,
alternatively, press Side Key b to move cursor down
u/l: When items are listed vertically, move cursor up
When the page is already scrolled to the top,
alternatively, press Side Key n to move cursor up
d/r/b
u/l/n
Scroll bar
d/r
u/l
Cursor
21-5
Mobile Internet
21
Previous or Next Page
Highlight link, etc. and press c to open the next page
Alternatively, select Options ψForward to
change the window
w (Back) or C: Display the previous page
Text Entry & Item Selection
An information window may show fields and items
below.
aText entry field
Enter data, certification passwords, etc.; highlight
Text entry field, press c and enter text
Tip
When items are listed in the same row
Press s to move cursor right or left.
When you move cursor
The selected item is highlighted or enclosed in a frame
of dotted lines if it is link to another page.
2.
海外のニュース
5.
スホ゜ーツ
c
w (Back)/C
Tip
•If w (Back)/C is pressed with no previous page
A message appears asking whether to terminate the
Web connection; select Yes to terminate the Web
connection.
aText entry field
bRadio
cMenu field
dCheck box
eCommand
21-6
Mobile Internet
21
bRadio button
Select one item only. Highlight an item with and
press c to select it (Appearing as ).
cMenu field
Open a menu and select an item. Highlight a menu,
press c to open it. Use j to highlight an item and press
c to select it. If multiple items are selectable, press C
to cancel all.
dCheck box
Select multiple items. Highlight an item with and
press c to select it (Appearing as ). To deselect an
item, highlight and press c.
eCommand button
Perform operations assigned to a button such as send
or reset. Highlight a command button and press c to
execute the operation.
Using Linked Info
Use embedded phone numbers, mail addresses, and
URLs to initiate calls, create and send messages, or
access web pages.
Available phone numbers, mail addresses, and URLs
are underlined.
Note
Text entry and item selection varies by page.
21-7
Mobile Internet
21
Using Page Links
AOpen a page containing linked info
BUse the available links
To initiate a Voice Call
Select a phone number and select Voice Call
To create and send messages
aSelect a phone number or mail address and
select Create message
bCreate messages and press w (Send)
To access another page
Select a URL
Saving to Phonebook
AOpen a page with linked number or
address
BSelect a number or address and select
Save Number or Save Address
Phone or USIM
CCreate a new entry or update an
existing entry
To save as a new entry
Select New
To add to an existing entry
aSelect Update
bSearch for an existing entry to modify ( P.5-
10)
DSelect an icon
ESave the item ( P.5-4)
FPress w(Save)
21-8
Mobile Internet Files
22-2
Mobile Internet Files
22
Using Image Files
Saving Images to Data Folder
Saving Linked Images
Download and save images from page links.
AOpen a page containing an image link
BSelect link
CPress c
When details appear
Press c
DPress C
To open the image
Press c (Launch)
To set saved image as Wallpaper
Press w (Set as) and perform Step 3 in
"Wallpaper" ( P.22-3)
Saving Page Images
Save a page image to Data Folder.
AOpen a page with an image
BSelect Options Save Save image
CHighlight the image and press
c (Save)
DPress C
To open the image
Press c (Launch)
To set saved image as Wallpaper
Press w (Set as) and perform Step 3 in
"Wallpaper" ( P.22-3)
EPress C to end the operation
To save another image
Repeat Step 3
22-3
Mobile Internet Files
22
Using Set As
Set a saved image as Wallpaper.
AOpen image ( P.22-2)
BPress w (Set as)
CSelect an item
To set as Wallpaper
aSelect Wallpaper
bPress c (Set)
To set as Phonebook entry image
aSelect Caller ID
bSearch Phonebook and select an entry ( P.5-
10)
cPress c (Set)
To set as Video Call Substitute Image
aSelect Still picture
bPress c (Save)
Tip
If the same file name exists
aPress c (Edit) and change the file name
bPress w (Save)
Viewing images
Press w (Set as) to set Wallpaper. ( P.22-3).
Press c (Zoom) to enlarge or reduce the image. Press
o (Details) to view image details.
When SVG-T/SWF format file is saved
Options appears on the save image confirmation
window, then select Options and execute various
operations
( P.11-9).
22-4
Mobile Internet Files
22
Using Sound Files
Playing Sound
Play sounds from page links.
AOpen a page containing link
BSelect link to sound
Saving Sounds to Data Folder
Download sound files from page links and save them
to Data Folder.
AOpen a page containing a sound link
BSelect link
CPress c
When details appear
Press c
DSelect Exit
To play sound
Select Launch
Note
For SVG-T/SWF format file, Settings does not
appear. For Wallpaper, open Data Folder and open
an image ( P.11-9).
22-5
Mobile Internet Files
22
Using Save Sound
Save background sound while viewing a page.
AOpen a page with sound
BSelect Options Save Save sound
CPress C
To play sound
Press c (Launch)
To set saved sound as Ringtone
Press w (Set as) and perform Step 3 in "Setting
Sound File as Ringtone" ( P.11-12)
Options
The items listed vary by the window status.
Tip
If same file name exists
aPress c (Edit) and change the file name
bPress w (Save)
To play sounds
Press w (Set as) and set saved sound as Ringtone
( P.11-12). For other operations, refer to Media
Player ( P.10-3).
Item Description
Stop Stop playing.
View bookmark
Access a page containing a
streaming play link saved as a
bookmark.
View history
Access a page containing a
streaming play link already
accessed.
Details Confirm sound size, etc.
Player settings Select settings related to Media
Player ( P.10-6).
22-6
Mobile Internet Files
22
Using Video Files
Playing a Video
Play video from a page link.
AOpen a page containing a video link
BSelect link
Saving Videos to Data Folder
Download and save videos from page links.
AOpen a page containing a video link
BSelect link
CPress c
When details appear
Press c
DPress C
To play video
Press c (Launch)
To set saved video as Ringtone
Press w (Set as) and perform Step 3 in "Setting
Video File as Ringtone" ( P.11-12)
Options
The items listed vary by the window status.
Tip
If same file name exists
aPress c (Edit) and change the file name
bPress w (Save)
To play video
Press w (Set as) and set saved video as Ringtone
( P.11-12). For other operations, refer to Media
Player ( P.10-8).
Item Description
Resolution Set video display size while playing
or paused.
22-7
Mobile Internet Files
22
Streaming
Enjoy audio visual media while it downloads. Access
compatible files via page links, etc. Downloaded
content cannot be saved.
AOpen a page containing a streaming
video link
BSelect link
Options
Selectable menu content varies by file.
View bookmark
Access a page containing a
streaming play link saved as a
bookmark.
View history
Access a page containing a
streaming play link already
accessed.
Details Set video size while playing or
paused.
Player settings
Select settings related to Media
Player
( P.10-11).
Item Description Tip
To stream files
Operate the same as Media Player ( P.10-3, 10-8).
Note
Even if streaming is paused, data transfer continues
and packet transmission fees apply.
Item Description
Resolution Set video size while playing or
paused.
Add bookmark Save current page containing a
streaming play link as a bookmark.
View bookmark
Access a page containing a
streaming play link saved as a
bookmark.
View history
Access a page containing a
streaming play link already
accessed.
22-8
Mobile Internet Files
22
Saving Pages
Saving a Page
Save current page to open it at any time without
accessing the Web. Save up to 50 pages.
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Saved pages Save
Opening a Saved Page
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Saved pages
BSelect a page
Changing a Title
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Saved pages
BHighlight a page, select Options
Rename
CPress c (Edit) and change the name
DPress w (Save)
22-9
Mobile Internet Files
22
Deleting a Saved Page
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Saved pages
BDelete as required
To delete one page
aHighlight a page
bOptions ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
To delete multiple pages
aOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
bCheck a page to delete
cRepeat Step b to check all target pages
dPress w (Delete) and select Yes
To delete all pages
aOptions ψDelete ψAll
bEnter Phone Password, press w (OK) and
select Yes
Saving Bookmarks
Saving as a Bookmark
Bookmark frequently visited sites (URLs) for easier
access. Save up to 30 Bookmarks.
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Bookmarks Add
to Bookmarks
Tip
To select/deselect multiple pages at once
aIn Step 2, select Options ψDelete ψMultiple
bOptions ψMark all/Unmark all
22-10
Mobile Internet Files
22
CConfirm Title and URL
To change the title/URL
aSelect Title or URL field
bChange Title or URL
DPress w (Save)
Opening a Bookmark
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Bookmarks
BSelect a bookmark
Editing Bookmarks
Modify the title or URL of bookmark.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Bookmarks
BHighlight a bookmark, select Options
Edit bookmark
CSelect Title field or URL field, and
modify the title or URL
DPress w (Save)
Tip
To manually enter and save a bookmark
aPress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψBookmarks
bOptions ψAdd bookmark
cSelect Subject field and enter a subject
dSelect URL field and enter a URL
ePress w (Save)
Tip
To send a bookmark URL via S! Mail
aIn Step 2, highlight a bookmark, select Options ψ
Send URL
bCreate a message and press w (Send)
22-11
Mobile Internet Files
22
Deleting a Bookmark
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
Bookmarks
BDelete as required
To delete one bookmark
aHighlight a bookmark
bOptions ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
To delete multiple bookmarks
aOptions ψ Delete ψMultiple
bCheck a bookmark to delete
cRepeat b to check all target bookmarks
dPress w (Delete) and select Yes
To delete all bookmarks
aOptions ψDelete ψ All
bEnter Phone Password, press w (OK) and
select Yes
History
Holds up to 50 page URLs; open previously viewed
pages.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai
History
BUse History records
To open a History record
Select URL
To delete a History record
aHighlight the URL
bOptions ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
Tip
To select/deselect multiple bookmarks at once
aIn Step 2, select Options ψDelete ψMultiple
bOptions ψMark all/Unmark all
22-12
Mobile Internet Files
22
To delete multiple records
aOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
bCheck a record to delete
cRepeat b to check all target records
dPress w (Delete) and select Yes
To delete all records
aOptions ψDelete ψAll
bEnter Phone Password, press w (OK) ψYes
Display Settings
Rendering
Set pages to match Display size or show only text.
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Rendering
CSelect an item
To open a page without changing its layout
Select Wide
To fit page to Display
Select Standard
To show page text only
Select Simple
Tip
To select/deselect multiple histories collectively
aIn Step 2, select Options ψDelete ψMultiple
bOptions ψMark all/Unmark all
Default
Setting
عStandard
22-13
Mobile Internet Files
22
Search Text
AOpen Information window
BSelect Options Search text
CSelect Text entry field and enter text
DSelect search direction and press
w (Search)
Copy Text
AOpen Information window
BSelect Options Copy Text
CIn a text entry window, select Options
Copy
DUse a to move cursor on the first
character and press c (Start)
To copy all texts in text entry window
Press o (All) to copy
EUse a to specify the range and press c
(End)
Reload
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Reload
22-14
Mobile Internet Files
22
Page Details
View current page information including URL and
Title.
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Browser setting
Page details
Send URL
Attach current page URL to a message and send it.
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Send URL
CCreate a message and press w (Send)
Server Certificate
View SSL/TLS server certificates.
AOpen a secure page
BSelect Options Browser setting
Certificates
CSelect Server certification and select a
certificate
Tip
When you open a page that uses SSL/TLS
appears at the top of Display.
22-15
Mobile Internet Files
22
Returning to Default Page
Return to the Yahoo! Keitai main menu.
AOpen a page
BFrom any page, select Options
Yahoo! Keitai
Encoding
If page text appears garbled, change character
encoding.
AOpen a page
BSelect Options Browser setting
Encoding
CSelect an option and press c (Save)
Information Window Options
Default
Setting
عAuto
Item Description
Forward Move to the next information window
( P.21-5).
Bookmark Add or open bookmarks ( P.22-9).
Saved pages
Save information windows to Saved
pages. Display information window from
Saved pages ( P.22-8, 22-8).
Search text Search text in information window
( P.22-13).
Reload Reload the information for a page
( P.22-13).
Enter URL Enter a URL to open another site/page
( P.21-3).
Rendering Change the displaying method for pages
( P.22-15).
Copy text Copy text in information window
( P.22-13).
Save Save images and sounds to Data Folder
( P.22-2, 22-4).
22-16
Mobile Internet Files
22
Send URL Send URLs of a page in a message
( P.22-14).
History Access previously viewed pages ( P.22-
11).
Yahoo! Keitai Return to Yahoo! Keitai main menu
( P.22-15).
Browser
setting Adjust Web Browser settings.
Text size Adjust information window text size
( P.23-3).
Download
s
Set image/sound download settings
( P.23-2).
Empty
cache Delete all information in cache.
Empty
cookies Delete all cookies.
Cookie
options Activate or cancel cookies.
Certificate
sView certificates ( P.22-14, 23-4).
Page
details View page details ( P.22-14).
Item Description
Manufactur
e No.
Show or hide handset serial number.
Encoding Change current page character encoding
( P.22-15).
Java Script Turn Java Script onoff ( P.23-3).
About
browser View browser details.
Item Description
Other Web Settings
23-2
Other Web Settings
23
Preferences
Set 820SC to disable embedded images/sounds when
opening pages. Pages download more quickly
without image and sound data.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings ψDownloads
BPerform operations to set
To disable images
aSelect Display images
bSelect an item and press w (Save)
To disable sounds
aSelect Play sound
bSelect an item and press w (Save)
Security
Cookie Options
Allow or reject small data files created by Web
servers and saved on handset. Cookies contain user
information allowing sites to recognize users and
track preferences.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings ψCookie options
BSelect an item and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عDisplay images: Checked
عPlay sound: Checked Default
Setting
عAccept all
Tip
Cookie options Items
Accept all: Always accept Cookies.
Reject all: Always reject Cookies.
Prompt: Confirm Cookies each time they appear.
23-3
Other Web Settings
23
Turning Java Script On/Off
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings ψJava script
BSelect an item and press c (Save)
Text Size
Change the size of the page fonts.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings Text size
BSelect an item and press c (Save)
Manufacture Number
Set 820SC to automatically send handset serial
number to Websites upon request for user
identification.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings ψManufacture
number
BSelect an item and press c (Save)
Browser Information
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings About browser
Default
Setting
عOff
Default
Setting
عNormal
Default
Setting
عOff
23-4
Other Web Settings
23
Certificates
View electronic certificate saved on 820SC.
AOpen a page using SSL/TLS
BSelect Options Browser setting
Certificates
CSelect Root certificate to view the
certificate
Refresh Browser
Empty Cache/Empty Cookies
Delete information saved in Cache and Cookies.
APress c and select Yahoo! Keitai ψ
Browser settings
BDelete as required
To delete Cache contents
Select Empty cache ψ c (Yes)
To delete Cookies
Select Empty cookies ψ c (Yes)
S! Appli
24-2
S! Appli
24
Getting Started
S! Appli
Download 820SC-compatible S! Appli, including
games, 3D images, and information via Mobile
Internet sites.
Use only compatible S! Appli.
To download S! Appli, separate subscription is
required and communication fees apply.
Network S! Appli
Some S! Appli require network connection. Enjoy
network gaming or access real-time information like
stock prices.
A separate subscription is required to download
S! Appli or use those which require network
connection.
Connection fees apply.
Downloading S! Appli
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list
BSelect Download S! Appli
CSelect S! Appli to download
DSelect Yes
When details appear
Press c
ESelect Exit
To activate S! Appli
Select Launch
24-3
S! Appli
24
Starting S! Appli
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list
BSelect S! Appli and press c (Start)
Exit, Pause, & Resume
Exiting or Pausing S! Appli
AWhile an S! Appli is active, press y
BChoose to exit/pause
To exit S! Appli
Press w (Exit)
To pause S! Appli
Press c (Pause)
Tip
When S! Appli is active
appears.
Tip
When S! Appli is paused
820SC returns to Standby and appears.
When 820SC is closed while S! Appli is active
S! Appli is paused.
24-4
S! Appli
24
Restarting a Paused S! Appli
AIn Standby with S! Appli paused,
press c and select S! Appli
BPress w (Resume)
Managing S! Appli
Details
Open Details to confirm S! Appli properties.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list
BHighlight a S! Appli, select Options
Details
Lock/Unlock
Lock S! Appli to prevent accidental deletion.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list
BHighlight S! Appli, select Options
Lock
Tip
S! Appli properties
Open Details to see following properties:
Name, Description, Profiles, Certification, Size,
Record Size, Version, and Vendor.
Tip
Locked S! Appli Indicator
In S! Appli list, appears.
To cancel lock
In Step 2, highlight locked S! Appli, select Options ψ
Unlock
24-5
S! Appli
24
Delete
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list
BDelete S! Appli
To delete one S! Appli
Options ψDelete ψSelected ψYes
To delete multiple S! Appli
aOptions ψDelete ψMultiple
bCheck S! Appli to delete
cRepeat Step b to check all target S! Appli
dPress w (Delete) and select Yes
To delete all S! Appli
aOptions ψDelete ψAll
bEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) and
select Yes
cSelect Yes to delete all S! Appli or No to
exclude locked ones
mPet
With 820SC mPet, raise your own virtual pet. Train
or enjoy playing games with.
Selecting Pet
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list mPet Yes
Tip
When all S! Appli are checked
In Step 2, perform a to c in "To delete multiple S!
Appli," press w (Delete) in d and proceed the
following procedures
aEnter Phone Password, press c (Confirm) and select
Yes
bSelect Yes to delete all S! Appli or No to exclude
locked ones
To select/deselect multiple S! Appli at once
aIn Step 2, select Options ψDelete ψMultiple
bOptions ψMark all or Unmark all
24-6
S! Appli
24
BUse s to select the pet and press c
(Select)
To select pet after checking action
Select Options ψanimate and press c (Select)
To select pet after checking direction
Select Options ψturn and press c (Select)
CEnter a name
DSelect Yes and press c
Emotion Indicator
mPet Window
Tip
After selecting your pet
Garden appears. Play Stanga, Train, Commend or
Discipline pet, or change Location. Last active
Location appears first.
Pet behavior
If no action is performed, pet becomes impatient and
barks; emotion text bubbles appear. If battery is low,
pet crouches.
To end mPet
Press C or y
To set mPet as Wallpaper ( P.8-2)
mPet Help
Use mPet Help to see other operations. In mPet
window, select Options ψHelp or press o while Help
appears.
24-7
S! Appli
24
mPet Operations
Navigation Modes & Operations
Open Options, then select Options to set Navigation.
When set to Shortcut mode, use number keys to
move your pet. When set to Walking mode, use a to
move your pet. Available operations vary by
location.
Locatio
n
Operation
Description
Shortcut
mode
Walking
mode
Garden
1Notes
(Top Left)
Play Ding Dong
game
2Front Door
(Top Center)
Go to Living
Room
3Flower Bed
(Top Right) Go for a walk
4
Ball
(Bottom
Right)
Play Stanza
game
Living
Room
1Door
(Top Left) Go to Garden
2Back Door
(Top Right) Go to Kitchen
Kitchen
1Back Door
(Top Left)
Go to Living
Room
2Door
(Top Right) Go to Bed Room
3
Bowl
(Bottom
Right)
Feed Meal
4
Today's
Saying
(Bottom
Left)
Show Today's
Saying
5Snacks
(Top Center) Feed Snacks
Locatio
n
Operation
Description
Shortcut
mode
Walking
mode
24-8
S! Appli
24
Action
In mPet window, press w (Action) to Train,
Commend or Discipline pet; its growth changes with
experience.
Bed
Room
1Door
(Top Left) Go to Kitchen
2
Laundry
Basket
(Top Center)
Bathe pet
Bed
Room
3Dog House
(Top Right) Put Pet to Bed
4
Book
(Bottom
Right)
English Quiz
5
Injector
(Bottom
Left)
Medicate pet
Locatio
n
Operation
Description
Shortcut
mode
Walking
mode
Item Description
Train
Sit Teach pet to sit down.
Roll Teach pet to roll over.
Turn Teach pet to turn around.
Bark Teach pet to bark.
Paw Teach pet to give you a paw.
Commend
Praise Praise pet for good behavior.
Pet Comfort pet for good behavier,
etc.
Discipline Warn Command pet to behave.
Punish Punish pet for bad behavior.
Tip
When pet refuses to behave
Pet may disobey instructions depending on the number
of times an instruction is given or the pet's condition.
Instruct pet again or check its condition and remedy
any problems.
After an action
Pet barks and responds; an emotion text bubble appears
and status window opens. Check status by Health,
Fatigue,Fullness,Clean,Stress,Obedient or Intimacy.
24-9
S! Appli
24
Options
Other Operations
Adopt a New Pet
Adopt up to five pets.
AIn mPet window, select Options Pet
Inventory
BSelect Options Adopt New pet
CPerform Steps 2 and 3 in "Select Pet"
( P.24-5)
Pet Inventory
AIn mPet window, select Options Pet
Inventory
BSelect a pet
Item Description
Location Select from Garden,Living room,
Kitchen or Bedroom.
Pet Inventory Open for additional options for
the specified pet ( P.24-9).
Pet Status See pet's physical and emotional
state.
Options Select mPet sound/display settings
( P.24-10).
Help See a basic mPet description. Tip
•Pet status
In Step 2, select Options ψView status
Rename your pet
aIn Step 2, highlight the pet
bOptions ψRename
cEnter a name
24-10
S! Appli
24
Say Goodbye
AIn mPet window, select Options Pet
Inventory
BHighlight pet and select Options
Say Goodbye
CPress o (Yes)
DPress c
Sound & Navigation
AIn mPet window, select Options
Options
BPerform operations
To set pet sound
aSelect Sound
bSelect an item and Press c
To set operation mode
aSelect Navigation
bSelect an item and Press c
To set action menu sound
aSelect Sound type
bSelect an item and Press c
CPress c
Note
Once given up, pet cannot be restored.
Default
Setting
عSound: Sound only
عNavigation: Shortcut mode
عSound type: Voice
24-11
S! Appli
24
Comic Surfing
ࠦࡒ࠶ࠢࠨ࡯ࡈࠖࡦ is the file viewer for browsing
electronic comic/photo book files (CCF files) saved
in Book folder in Data Folder. Enlarge/reduce
images, scroll page, browse images with sound/
vibration effects.
To browse CCF files, acquire Content Key. No
Content Key is required to browse the default sample
files in 820SC.
Browsing Electronic Comic
APress c and select S! Appli
S! application list
Tip
Sound Items
Sound & Vibrate: Pet barks and 820SC vibrates
simultaneously.
Sound only: Pet barks.
Vibrate: 820SC vibrates with no pet barking.
No sound: No vibration and with no pet barking.
Navigation Items
Shortcut mode: Show available shortcuts indicators in
mPet window to use assigned shortcuts keys.
Walking mode: Use a to move locations with the pet.
Sound type Items
Voice: Indicate the selected action operation by voice.
Melody: Indicate the selected action operation by
melody.
Tip
After starting
Refer to in .
コミックサーフィン
ヘルプ コミックサーフィン
24-12
S! Appli
24
Security
Set access/confirmation condition for S! Appli.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Application list
BHighlight S! Appli, select Options
Permissions
CSelect items
For Mobile Internet access
Select Net Access
For automatic activation
Select Application Autoinvocation
For external device connection
Select Local connectivity
For read user data access
Select Read user data access
For write user data access
Select Write user data access
DSelect items and press c (Save)
Default
Setting
عNet Access: Per session
عApplication Autoinvocation: Per session
عLocal connectivity: Per session
عRead user data access: Per access
عWrite use data access: Per access
24-13
S! Appli
24
S! Appli Settings
Make S! Appli settings and restore defaults.
Backlight
Set Display settings for the backlight.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Appli settings Backlight
BSelect the setting and press c
Application Volume
Adjust the volume of sounds.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Appli settings Application
Volume
Tip
Permissions Items
Select one item for each application; available options
vary.
Always: Confirmation does not appear.
Per session: Confirmation appears once per session.
Per access: Confirmation appears each time
application is accessed.
Never: Confirmation does not appear.
To restore defaults
In Step 3, select Reset ψYes
Default
Setting
عNormal settings
Tip
Backlight Items
Always On: Set the backlight always on.
Always Off: Set the backlight always off.
Normal settings: Settings of Backlight time ( P.8-7)
for Display settings take priority.
Default
Setting
عLevel 3
24-14
S! Appli
24
BUse a to adjust volume and press c
Vibration
Activate to use vibration with compatible S! Appli.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Appli settings Vibration
BSelect an item and press c
S! Appli Sort
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Appli settings S! Appli Sort
BSelect an item and press c
Reset S! Appli Settings
Restore S! Appli settings to defaults.
APress c and select S! Appli
S! Appli settings Reset S! Appli
settings
BEnter Phone Password, press
c (Confirm) and select Yes
Tip
Sound volume in Manner Profile
Manner Profile Phone sounds settings apply.
Default
Setting
عON
Default
Setting
عBy Date
Appendix
25-2
Appendix
25
Functions
Main Menu
Item Item Page
S! Appli S! Application list P.24-2
S! Appli Settings P.24-13
Yahoo! Keitai
Yahoo! Keitai P.21-3
Bookmarks P.22-9
Saved pages P.22-8
Enter URL P.21-3
History P.22-11
Browser settings P.23-2
Media Player Music P.10-3
Video P.10-8
Camera
Take photo P.7-5
Record video P.7-11
Go to photos P.7-6
Go to videos P.7-12
Dynamic effect list P.7-19
Video editor P.7-17
Data Folder
Pictures P.11-2
Videos P.11-2
Sounds &
Ringtones P.11-2
S! Appli P.11-2
Book P.11-2
Other documents P.11-2
Memory status P.11-3
Messaging
Received msgs P.17-4, 18-2
Create msg P.17-8
Drafts P.18-8
Unsent msgs P.18-9
Sent msgs P.18-8
Templates P.17-15
Server mail box P.19-2
Settings P.20-2, 20-5
Memory status P.18-2
Main Menu
Item Item Page
25-3
Appendix
25
Tools
Alarms P.14-2
Calendar P.14-5
Voice recorder P.14-15
World clock P.14-18
Calculator P.14-19
Converter P.14-20
Stopwatch P.14-22
Dictionary P.14-23
Slide show P.8-2
Interpreter P.14-23
Memory status P.14-13
Phonebook Phonebook list P.5-10
Main Menu
Item Item Page
Settings
Phone settings -
Sound settings P.9-4
Display settings P.8-1
Call settings -
Phonebook settings P.5-1
Connectivity P.12-1
Security P.13-1
Software update P.25-10
Memory settings P.13-10, 15-9
Main Menu
Item Item Page
25-4
Appendix
25
Troubleshooting
ع820SC does not turn on
"Is battery empty?
#Replace or charge battery.
"Is battery installed in 820SC?
#Install battery correctly.
عWhen power is turned on, PIN entry
window appears
"Is PIN lock set to Enable?
#If PIN lock is Enable, enter PIN.
عWhen power is turned on, USIM
password entry window appears
"Is USIM lock set to Enable?
#If USIM lock is Enable, enter USIM
password.
عPlease insert USIM card or This card
cannot be recognized appears when
820SC is turned on or executing a function
"Is USIM Card correctly installed?
#Check to see if USIM Card is correctly
installed. If the message appears even
though USIM Card is correctly installed,
it may be damaged.
"Is an incorrect USIM Card used?
#Check to see if correct USIM Card is
used. Use USIM Card specified by
SoftBank.
"Is there debris on USIM Card IC chip?
#Remove debris with a clean, dry cloth,
and then install USIM Card correctly.
25-5
Appendix
25
عReading USIM Cannot operate or Reading
USIM Card Cannot start appears
#USIM Card data is being read. Try again
later.
عA Busy tone continues after dialing
"Have you entered a phone number
beginning with zero such as an area code?
#Enter a phone number beginning with
zero such as an area code.
"Is 820SC set to Offline mode?
(appears)
#Change 820SC to another mode such as
Normal.
ع or appears and no calls can be
initiated
"820SC is out-of-range.
#Move to a place where the signal is
stronger and try again.
عCalls are interrupted or disconnected
"Does or appear?
#Move to a place where the signal is
stronger and try again.
"Is battery empty?
#Replace or charge battery.
عUnable to initiate a call
"Is Call Barring set?
#Deactivate Call Barring.
25-6
Appendix
25
عUnable to open Phonebook entry, Data
Folder, Call Log, Calendar, or Messaging
"Is Privacy lock set?
#Cancel Privacy lock.
عClicking noise is heard during a call
"Noise may be generated when signal is
weak or while moving between coverage
areas.
عUnable to charge battery
"Is AC Charger Connector securely
inserted?
#Insert AC Charger Connector securely.
"Is AC Charger plug securely inserted?
#Insert AC Charger plug securely.
"Is battery installed in 820SC?
#Install battery correctly.
"Are 820SC terminals, battery terminals
and AC Charger clean?
#Clean contacts with a dry cotton swab.
"Was battery charged in ambient
temperature below 5 ºC or above 40 ºC.
#Charge battery in ambient temperature
between 5 ºC and 40 ºC.
"Battery may need to be replaced.
#Install a new battery.
"Does battery always lose its charge
quickly after being charged?
#Battery life has expired. Replace with a
new battery.
25-7
Appendix
25
"Does 820SC or battery become very
warm during charging?
#If the temperature rises too much,
charging may stop. After 820SC and
battery are cool, retry charging.
عDevices become hot
"During charging, AC Charger may heat
up.
"820SC may heat up during charging/long
calls.
#If 820SC can be touched with your hand,
it is normal. If it is too hot to touch,
immediately stop charging and contact
Customer Service ( P.25-25).
عBattery drains quickly
"Battery may drain quickly depending on
the operating environment (Ambient
temperature, charging conditions, or
Signal Strength), operations, and settings.
#Use 820SC in an appropriate environment
and reduce operations requiring high
power ( P.1-14).
عDisplay flickers
"Is 820SC used near a fluorescent light?
#Use 820SC as far away from a fluorescent
light as possible.
عDisplay is dim or unlit
"This may be due to the characteristics of
Display and not a problem. The time
(seconds) until Display is dimmed or unlit
25-8
Appendix
25
can be changed by adjusting the
Backlight time.
عUnable to play music through speaker
"Is Manner Profile set?
#Cancel Manner Profile.
"Is the stereo earphone microphone
connected?
#Disconnect the connector for the stereo
earphone microphone from 820SC.
عToo many applications are already running,
thus unable to launch anymore appears
"Memory is low or full.
#Delete unnecessary S! Mail messages. If
multiple functions are active, close some.
عUnable to establish Bluetooth® or USB
connections using Samsung PC Studio
"Is the USB driver installed? (for USB
connection)
#If communications are executed
connecting to a personal computer with
the supplied USB cable, installing the
driver is required. Install the driver from
the supplied CD-ROM.
"Is the connection method set correctly on
the personal computer?
#Set the connection method to USB or
Bluetooth on the Connection Manager of
Samsung PC Studio or the Connection
Wizard for the communication in use.
25-9
Appendix
25
"Are Bluetooth® or PC USB connection
port and Samsung PC Studio the same?
#Make sure port settings match those set
for Samsung PC Studio Connection
Manager or Connection Wizard.
عSome Phonebook entries do not appear
"Is 820SC set to Hide in Secret Mode?
#Set to Show in Secret Mode.
عMessage cannot be created
"Shared Memory may be full.
#Delete messages. If less than 464 KB,
messages cannot be created.
عTry again appears
"Signal conditions are poor.
#Move for a stronger signal and try again.
عSending message failed or Unknown error
appears
"Network connection failed.
#Try again later.
عAll available connections are busy appears
"New S! Mail arrives while 820SC is
being used for packet data
communications.
#End the data communication and try
again.
عService unavailable appears
"820SC is outside the service area.
#Send from within the service area.
عNo response appears
"Network/Server is busy.
#Try again later.
25-10
Appendix
25
عChange from flight profile to other profile
for network service,created message will be
saved in outbox appears
"Offline mode is active.
#Cancel Offline mode and try again.
عCannot download because of too large data
appears
"S! Appli memory is full.
#Delete unnecessary S! Appli and try
again.
عReceived invalid data. Quit download or
Cannot download because of too large data
appears
#File cannot be downloaded; cancel
download.
Software Update
Check for 820SCΤ software updates and download
as required. Choose to begin Update or Schedule
update.
APress c and select Settings Software
update
BPress w (Yes)
820SC connects to network.
CRead Terms of Use and select Agree
Read through Terms of Use before selecting
Agree.
DEnter Center Access Code ( P.1-27)
and press c
Update Result appears.
25-11
Appendix
25
EPress c
To update immediately
Select Update now to start the update. When
completed, 820SC turns the power off and on
again; then Notification window appears.
To schedule later update
aSelect Schedule update
bPress w (Yes)
cSelect schedule date and press c
dSelect schedule time and press c
eConfirm schedule date & time and press c
Notification Window
Tip
•Procedures
Find details on SoftBank Website (http://
www.softbank.jp).
Connection fees
No fees are applied to update checks or downloads.
Scheduled update time
Notification appears. Press c or wait ten seconds.
Update will not start while 820SC is in use. When
operation ends, confirmation window appears.
However if operation does not end within ten minutes
of scheduled update time, scheduled update is
automatically canceled.
To cancel Schedule update
aPerform Steps 1 to 5, select Cancel schedule
bPress w (Yes)
Notification Window
25-12
Appendix
25
Symbols & Pictograms
Symbols
Double-byte Symbols
Note
Charge battery beforehand; if low, update may fail.
If Scheduled update time arrives while 820SC is
out-of-range, Software Update is canceled.
Remain within strong, stable signal conditions.
820SC Phonebook entries, media files, and other
contents are not affected by software updates, but
always back-up important information (note that
some files cannot be copied). SoftBank is not liable
for damages from lost information, etc.
820SC transmissions are disabled during update.
Update may take some time to complete.
Update failure may disable 820SC. Contact
SoftBank Customer Center, Customer Assistance.
25-13
Appendix
25
Single-byte Symbols
Symbol Conversions
Symbol
Label Symbol Symbol
Label Symbol
޽ߞߣ 㧬
"
ߎ߼ ̪
޿ߎ࡯ࠆ 㧩
ߎࠈࠎ 㧦㧧
߃ࠎ
ߐࠎ߆ߊ ًٌٖٕ
߅ࠎ߲ ۭ ߒ߆ߊ غع٠ٟ
߆ߌࠆ  ߤ߁ ࠒޖޘ
߆ߞߎ ޟޠޡޢޣޤޛޜ
=?̈
ޓ
̉̌
ޓ
̍
ޓ
ާ
ޓ
ި
ޓ
ޓ
ޛ
ޓ
ޜޝ
ޓ
ޞ
߬࡯ߖࠎߣ 
߶ߒ ڏڎ
߹ࠆ ٤٨٧
߆ࠄ ߿ߓࠆߒ ψφχω
25-14
Appendix
25
Pictograms
Pictograms with are animated.
25-15
Appendix
25
Some pictograms and animated pictograms may not appear properly on some models of SoftBank handsets or other
devices.
25-16
Appendix
25
Memory List Specifications
820SC specifications may change without prior
notice.
SoftBank 820SC
820SC with battery installed.
Shared Memory
S! Mail
Received msgs Up to 500 messages
Drafts Up to 10 messages
Unsent msgs Up to 10 messages
Sent msgs Up to 250 messages
SMS
Received msgs Up to 500 messages
Drafts Up to 10 messages
Unsent msgs Up to 10 messages
Sent msgs Up to 250 messages
Data Folder
Pictures
Up to 999 items
(files and
subfolders) per
folder
Videos
Sounds &
Ringtones
S! Appli
Book
Other documents
Item Specification
Weight Approximately 95 g
Continuous Talk
Time
Voice Call:
Approximately 165 minutes (3G)
Approximately 310 minutes
(GSM)
Video Call:
Approximately 100 minutes (3G)
Continuous Standby
Time (820SC closed
and sub Display
OFF)
Approximately 255 hours (3G)
Approximately 300 hours (GSM)
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Approximately 51.4 x 102.5 x
11.9 (820SC closed)
Maximum Output 0.25 W
25-17
Appendix
25
Battery Time is calculated by SoftBank under
stable signal conditions. Calling in poor signal
conditions or leaving 820SC on out-of-range will
consume more power and may reduce Battery
Time by more than half.
Frequent 820SC operations requiring Backlight
(e.g., Yahoo! Keitai) may reduce Continuous Talk
Time and Continuous Standby Time.
Using video for Wallpaper may significantly
reduce Continuous Talking and Continuous
Standby Times.
Using S! Appli may reduce Continuous Talking
and Continuous Standby Times.
Continuous Talk Time is an average measured with
a new, fully charged battery in stable signal
conditions. Continuous Standby Time is an
average measured with a new, fully charged battery
with 820SC closed without calls or operations, in
Standby, in stable signal conditions. Alternating
between usage and Standby shortens Continuous
Talk Time and Continuous Standby Time. Talk
Time/Standby Time may vary by environment
(battery status, ambient temperature, etc.).
Battery
AC Charger
Item Specification
Voltage 3.7 V
Type Lithium-ion
Capacity 880 mAh
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Approximately 46.3 x 36.9 x 5.2
mm
(without protruding parts)
Item Specification
Power Source AC 100 V-240 V, 50/60 Hz
(with power cable)
Output Voltage/
Current DC 5 V/720 mA
Charging
Temperature 5 to 40 ºC
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Approximately 53 x 49 x 20 mm
(without cables)
Cord Length Approximately 180 cm
25-17
Appendix
25
INDEX
A
AC Charger .............................................1-15
Acoustic shock ........................................15-5
Activate Secret mode .........................13-6
Activating Bluetooth® .......................12-4
Activating S! Appli ..............................24-3
Active Folder ...........................................15-6
Add to playlist ........................................10-4
Adding Reject Black List ................13-9
Adjusting earpiece volume ...............2-7
Adjusting ringtone volume ...... 2-3,6-3
Adjusting volume level to play
.......................................................... 10-7,10-11
Alarms .........................................................14-2
All music ....................................................10-3
Anniversary .............................................14-9
Answer Machine .....................................2-5
Answering mode ...................................12-9
Anykey answer ......................................15-5
Applicable Profiles for Bluetooth®
...................................................................... 12-2
Attaching files ...................................... 18-13
Attaching to a message for sending
still images ........................................... 7-20
Attaching to a message for sending
videos ............................................7-20,11-13
Attaching/Inserting a file .............. 17-14
Audio Skin ............................................... 10-7
Auto power ON ..................................... 14-4
Auto redial ............................................... 15-2
B
Backlight ................................ 8-7,10-8,24-13
Battery ...............................................1-11,1-13
Bluetooth® ................................................ 12-2
Bluetooth® Address ........................... 12-3
Bluetooth® service .............................. 12-3
Browser Information ........................ 23-3
C
Cache ........................................................... 21-2
Calculator ............................................... 14-19
Calendar ....................................................14-5
Calendar window format ................14-6
Call answer mode ..................................9-3
Call cost limit ..........................................2-12
Call Log Records ....................................2-9
Call Transfer service .........................16-3
Call Waiting ............................................16-8
Caller ID ..................................................16-13
Camera .........................................................7-2
Camera mode ...........................................7-4
Camera setting .......................................7-13
Capturing continuous images ........7-8
Capturing in Mosaic shot .................7-9
Capturing mode ......................................7-4
Capturing still images .........................7-5
Capturing videos ..................................7-10
Category ......................................................5-7
Centre access code ...............................1-23
Certificates ................................... 22-16,23-4
Changing a file name .......................11-14
Changing a folder name .... 11-14,18-15
Changing mail address .....................20-2
Changing phone password .............13-2
25-18
Appendix
25
Changing PIN .........................................13-2
Changing PIN2 ......................................13-2
Changing profile .....................................3-3
Changing settings of each profile
........................................................................9-2
Changing to SMS ...............................17-11
Changing to S! mail ..........................17-11
Changing voice recorder settings
....................................................................14-17
Charger Port .............................................1-8
Charging .......................................... 1-15,1-16
Checking memory usage ....... 15-8,18-2
Clear memory .......................................13-10
Clock Display ............................................8-4
Conference Call .....................................16-9
Connecting a Bluetooth®-
compatible device ................... 12-6,12-9
Connection to another Bluetooth
devices .....................................................12-6
Content key info ..................................11-14
Converting currency or unit .......14-20
Cookie setting .........................................23-2
Copy text ..................................................22-13
Copying characters ............................ 4-12
Copying files ......................................... 11-16
Copying folders ................................... 11-16
Copying items ........................................ 5-13
Copying Phonebook ........................... 5-15
Copyrighted file icons ....................... 18-5
Country code .......................................... 15-3
Creating a folder .....................11-14,18-15
Creating a play list ............................. 10-5
Creating messages ............................... 17-6
Current contacts .................................... 2-9
Cutting characters .............................. 4-12
D
Data folder ......................................7-15,11-2
Date and time setting ........................ 1-18
Default name ........................................ 14-17
Default style ............................................ 20-4
Deleting a bookmark ....................... 22-11
Deleting a file ........................................ 11-17
Deleting a folder ......................11-17,18-16
Deleting a Saved page ....................... 22-9
Deleting a S! Appli .............................. 24-5
Deleting access logs ...........................22-11
Deleting Cache .......................................23-4
Deleting Calendar items ................14-13
Deleting Call Log Records .............2-10
Deleting characters .............................4-11
Deleting Cookies ...................................23-4
Deleting messages ................................18-9
Deleting messages in server ...........19-3
Deleting My devices ............................12-5
Deleting Phonebook ............................5-15
Deleting still images ..............................7-6
Deleting templates ..........4-16,18-9,18-11
Dialed Call Log Records ...................2-9
Dialing display .........................................8-8
Dictionary ...............................................14-22
Display ..........................................................1-8
Display brightness .................................8-7
Display mode ..........................................14-7
Display Operator name ......................8-5
Display rendering ..............................22-12
Display size of videos .......................10-12
Displaying Slide show ......................17-12
Download Content Key ..................11-14
25-19
Appendix
25
Downloading a S! Appli ...................24-2
Drafts ...........................................................18-2
DTMF .................................................... 2-8,6-5
Dynamic effect list ...............................7-19
E
Earphone call ..........................................15-3
Editing bookmarks ...........................22-10
Editing Calendar details ................14-12
Editing Phonebook ..............................5-14
Editing still images ..............................7-15
Editing Style ..........................................17-12
Editing the title for a Saved page
......................................................................22-8
Editing Videos ........................................7-17
Effect sound and keypad tone
volume .......................................................9-2
Effect sound setting ...................... 9-3,9-7
Effects ..........................................................7-12
Encode .......................................................22-15
Entering a number to select an item
......................................................................1-21
Entering by quoting text ..................4-10
Entering characters ......................4-2,4-4
Entering emoticons ............................... 4-9
Entering pictograms ............................ 4-9
Entering symbols ................................... 4-9
Entering URL ........................................ 21-3
Entry mode for characters .............. 4-2
Event list .................................................. 14-12
External Device Port ........................... 1-8
F
File details .............................................. 11-14
File Viewer ............................................... 11-5
Font size .............................4-14,8-6,8-9,23-3
Forwarding .............................................. 18-8
Forwarding Messages ....................... 19-4
Forwarding messages in server .. 19-4
Frames .................................................7-6,7-16
G
Greeting Messages ................................ 8-9
H
Holiday .......................................................14-9
Home zone ................................................1-20
I
Icons for attached files ....................17-16
Icons for files ................................. 11-2,11-4
Icons on Drafts list ..............................18-4
Icons on My devices list ...................12-6
Icons on Received messages list
......................................................................18-4
Icons on Sent messages .....................18-5
Icons on Unsent messages list .......18-5
Image display ..........................................23-2
In-car charger ........................................1-16
Initiating a call ............................... 2-2,2-15
Initiating a call overseas ..................2-15
Initiating a Video Call ........................6-2
Initiating an international call
.............................................................. 2-2,2-15
Inserting/Removing USIM Card .1-3
Installing and removing battery .1-13
25-20
Appendix
25
International code ................................15-2
International roaming .......................2-13
Interpreter ..............................................14-23
Invoking a function with Switch Bar
......................................................................1-22
Invoking functions from Main menu
......................................................................1-20
Items to save to Phonebook .............5-2
J
Java Script ................................................23-3
Jump .............................................................4-13
K
Key assignments .....................................4-3
Keypad tone ...............................................9-3
L
Language ...................................................8-10
List Font Size ............................................8-6
Locking/unlocking .............................11-14
Locking/unlocking files ..................11-14
Locking/Unlocking sound files .. 14-17
Locking/Unlocking S! Appli ......... 24-4
M
Mail art function .................................. 17-6
Mail Server .............................................. 19-2
Mailbox ...................................................... 18-2
Main menu style ..................................... 8-5
Manner profile ........................................ 3-2
Mark default number ....................... 5-14
Maximum of message size .............. 20-4
Media Player .......................................... 10-2
Memo ......................................................... 14-10
Message ...................................................... 17-2
Message details ...................................... 18-3
Message List ........................................... 19-2
Message type icon ................................ 18-3
Missed Call .........................................2-4,2-9
Mobile Postcard ..................................... 7-7
Mobile tracker ....................................... 13-7
Modifying characters ........................ 4-11
Move to USIM ..................................... 18-20
mPet ............................................................. 24-5
mPostcard ...................................................7-6
Multi Selector ........................................... xiii
Mute ................................................2-3,2-8,9-3
My devices .............................12-4,12-8,12-9
My phone’s name ...............................12-11
My phone’s visibility ........................12-10
My phone’s visibility for Bluetooth®
....................................................................12-10
N
Network mode ........................................2-13
Network password ................... 1-24,16-13
Network Profile .....................................2-13
Network selection .................................2-14
Network S! Appli .................................24-2
O
Offline Profile ...........................................3-2
Opening Saved page ...........................22-8
Operating messages in server ......19-2
Operations available during a Video
Call ..............................................................6-3
Operations during a call ....................2-8
25-21
Appendix
25
Option menu ...........................................1-23
Outgoing/incoming call barring
service ....................................................16-11
Owner information .............................5-16
P
Page Details ............................................22-14
Page Window ..........................................21-4
Password Lock .......................................13-5
Pasting characters ...............................4-12
Phone lock .................................................13-5
Phonebook search ..................................5-9
PIN ..................................................................1-5
PIN authentication at power on
.............................................................. 1-5,13-3
PIN lock ......................................................13-3
PIN2 ................................................................1-5
PIN2 lock unlocking code ...............13-3
Player settings ............................ 10-6,10-11
Playing melody ......................................10-3
Playing video ................................. 7-15,10-8
Playing voice .........................................14-16
Popup menu ...............................................8-6
Power ON/OFF ............................1-17,1-18
Predictive entry function ON/OFF
...................................................................... 4-13
Preferences .............................................. 23-2
Preferred network .............................. 2-14
Pre-installed ............................................ 11-2
Print via Bluetooth® .......................... 12-7
Privacy Lock ........................................... 13-6
Providing Manufacturer Number
...................................................................... 23-3
PUK Code ..........................................1-5,13-3
Putting a call on hold .......................... 2-7
Q
Quoting for entries ............................. 4-10
R
Received call log ..................................... 2-9
Received messages .............................. 18-2
Receiving a call ....................................... 2-3
Receiving a Video Call ....................... 6-2
Receiving all messages ...................... 19-2
Receiving data via Bluetooth® .... 12-7
Receiving message in server ..........19-2
Receiving settings .................................20-3
Record settings ....................................14-17
Recording voice ...................................14-16
Registering an S! Mail Template
....................................................................18-19
Registering as S! Mail Template
......................................................................18-6
Registering SMS templates ............4-15
Registering to bookmark ................22-9
Registering to Phonebook .................5-4
Rejecting call reception ....................15-6
Rejecting incoming calls ..................13-8
Renaming a still image file ...............7-6
Renaming My devices .......................12-5
Renaming sound files ......................14-17
Repeat mode ................................ 10-6,10-11
Reply .................................................. 17-5,18-7
Reply with text .......................................20-6
Reset all ....................................................13-11
Reset settings ........................................13-11
Resetting a call cost ............................2-11
Resetting Call times ............................2-11
25-22
Appendix
25
Resetting PIN lock ...............................13-3
Resetting S! Appli settings ...........24-14
Restarting paused S! Appli ............24-4
Retry function ........................................17-2
Retry with ...................................................6-7
Ringtone for a Voice Call ..................5-8
S
Saving a page ..........................................22-8
Saving as a template .........................17-20
Saving attached files .........................18-14
Saving images .........................................22-2
Saving sounds .........................................22-5
Saving to Drafts ..................................17-19
Schedule .....................................................14-7
Search text ..............................................22-13
Search type ...............................................5-12
Secure mode for data transfer ...12-11
Security .....................................................24-12
Security Codes .......................................1-23
Selecting 3G or GSM .........................2-13
Sending a bookmark URL ...........22-10
Sending a message from Drafts ...18-8
Sending data via Bluetooth® ........ 12-6
Sending from Unsent Messages .. 18-9
Sending settings ............... 17-11,20-2,20-5
Sending sound files ........................... 14-16
Sending still images via Bluetooth®
...................................................................... 12-6
Sending URL ........................................ 22-14
Sending videos via Bluetooth®
.............................................................7-12,12-6
Sending your image .............................. 6-6
Sent messages ......................................... 18-2
Server Certification ......................... 22-14
Server Mail Size ................................... 19-2
Shortcut operations ............................ 7-10
Shortcuts ..........................................1-22,15-7
Side Key ..................................................... 15-6
Side Key Lock ........................................ 15-6
Simple Search Setting ....................... 15-7
Skin ............................................................... 10-8
Slide show ..........................................8-2,11-3
SMS .....................................................17-2,20-5
SMS templates ....................................... 4-10
Softkey ............................................................xii
Software Update .................................25-10
Sort .........................................11-9,14-13,18-17
Sorting files ..............................................11-9
Sound file details ................................14-17
Sound file setting ................................14-16
Sound playback .....................................23-2
Sound Settings .........................................9-4
Speaker Phone call ................................2-7
Speed dialing ...........................................5-12
SSL/TLS ....................................................21-2
SSL/TLS certificate ............................23-4
Still image details ...................................7-6
Stopping or Pausing S! Appli .......24-3
Stopwatch ...............................................14-22
Streaming ..................................................22-7
Sub LCD Light ........................................8-8
Substitute images ...................................6-6
SVG-T/Flash® Viewer ......................11-8
Switching callers .................................16-10
S! Appli .......................................................24-2
S! Appli detailed information ......24-4
S! Mail .........................................................17-2
S! Mail templates ...............................17-14
25-23
Appendix
25
T
Task ............................................................14-10
Templates ........................................ 4-10,18-2
Timer ...........................................................7-11
U
Unsent messages ...................................18-2
Updating information ......................22-13
Updating mail list .................................19-2
USB connection ...................................12-11
User dictionary ......................................4-14
USIM Card ................................................1-2
USIM lock .................................................13-4
USIM password .....................................13-5
Using a file ..............................................11-10
Using a template .................................17-14
Using SMS templates .........................4-15
V
Various settings for Video Call .....6-6
vFile ............................................................11-12
Vibration ....................................... 14-2,24-14
Vibrator/Sound settings .................... 9-2
Video Mode ............................................. 7-10
Video settings ......................................... 7-14
Viewfinder .................................................. 7-3
Viewing a file .......................................... 11-3
Viewing attached files ..................... 18-13
Viewing Call cost ................................. 2-11
Viewing Call Log Records ............... 2-9
Viewing Call times .............................. 2-11
Viewing Saved Calendar Entries
.................................................................... 14-12
Viewing your phone number
(My Phonebook details) .............. 5-16
Visualization ........................................... 10-7
Voice Mail Service .............................. 16-5
Voice Recorder .................................... 14-15
Volume ...................................... 2-7,9-2,24-13
W
Wake-up Alarm .................................... 14-2
Wallpaper ................................................... 8-2
Web .............................................................. 21-2
Web access from a bookmark ... 22-10
Web connection from access logs
....................................................................22-11
World clock ...........................................14-18
Y
Yahoo! Keitai ........................................22-16
Z
Zoom list ......................................................8-7
Numerics
3D Pictogram ..........................................20-5
25-24
Appendix
25
Warranty & After Sales
Service
Warranty
The purchased 820SC comes with a Warranty.
Check the shop and date of purchase.
Read through the contents of the Warranty and
keep it in a safe place.
The warranty period can be found in the Warranty.
SoftBank is not liable for damages to you or a third
party from missed calls, etc. due to handset failure or
malfunction, etc.
Repair Requests
Before submitting 820SC for repair, consult the
"Troubleshooting" section.
for a solution. If a problem persists, contact
Customer Service ( P.25-25) or the nearest
SoftBank shop; be prepared to describe problem in
detail.
During the warranty period, repairs will be made
under the terms and conditions described in the
warranty.
After the warranty period, repairs will be upon
request; if said repairs can be made, you will be
charged for them.
Note
820SC files and settings may be lost or altered due
to accidents or repairs. Keep a copy of important
files, etc. like Phonebook entries. SoftBank is not
liable for damages resulting from accidental loss or
alteration of 820SC files (Phonebook, Data Folder,
etc.) or settings.
Disassembling or modifying this product may be a
violation of the Radio Law. Note that SoftBank will
not accept repair requests for disassembled or
modified products.
25-25
Appendix
25
Customer Service
If you have questions about SoftBank handsets or services, please call General Information.
For repairs, please call Customer Assistance.
Call these numbers toll free from landlines.
SoftBank Customer Center SoftBank International Call Center
From a SoftBank handset, dial toll free at
157 for General Information or
113 for Customer Assistance
From outside Japan, dial +81-3-5351-3491
(Please take care to dial correctly;
international charges will apply.)
Subscription Areas Contact
Hokkaido, Aomori, Akita, Iwate, Yamagata, Miyagi, Fukushima,
Niigata, Tokyo, Kanagawa, Chiba, Saitama, Ibaraki, Tochigi,
Gunma, Yamanashi, Nagano, Toyama, Ishikawa, Fukui
General Information 0088-240-157 (Toll-
free)
Customer Assistance 0088-240-113 (Toll-
free)
Aichi, Gifu, Mie, Shizuoka
General Information 0088-241-157 (Toll-
free)
Customer Assistance 0088-241-113 (Toll-
free)
25-26
Osaka, Hyogo, Kyoto, Nara, Shiga, Wakayama
General Information 0088-242-157 (Toll-
free)
Customer Assistance 0088-242-113 (Toll-
free)
Hiroshima, Okayama, Yamaguchi, Tottori, Shimane, Tokushima,
Kagawa, Ehime, Kochi, Fukuoka, Saga, Nagasaki, Oita,
Kumamoto, Miyazaki, Kagoshima, Okinawa
General Information 0088-250-157 (Toll-
free)
Customer Assistance 0088-250-113 (Toll-
free)
Subscription Areas Contact
SoftBank 820SC User Guide
February 2007 Version 1
*For more information, please
visit your nearest SoftBank
SOFTBANK MOBILECorp.
Model name: SoftBank 820SC
Manufacturer:Samsung
Electronics Co.,
To help protect the environment and
recycle valuable resources, mobile
phone, and PHS shops displaying the
above mark accept mobile phones,
batteries, and chargers of all
manufacturers.
*Mobile phones, batteries, and chargers
collected for recycling cannot be
returned.
*To protect your privacy, delete any
personal information (telephone

Navigation menu